
分析天平高性能Unibloc电子天平AP系列
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1375" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fanalytical%2Fap-semimicro%2Fap_series.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Highly-sophisticated simulation technology produced advanced UniBloc AP ™
Increased weighing capacity from 135mg to 220g (0.01mg model)
Micro amount weighing over 135mg (read 0.01mg step) is possible.
Faster Response and Higher Stability
High Speed - Fast weighing response The response time for trace measurements (from 1 mg) is reduced to about 2 seconds. This significantly improves weighing efficiency.
Stress Free - A variety of accessories and options suitable for semi-micro measurements The STABLO-AP ionizer can be mounted. This eliminates the influence of static electricity, achieving reliable measurements in a simpler procedure.
For Regulation-for the Pharmaceutical Industry Interlocking with LabSolutions Balance enables compliance with a variety of regulations for measurement data integrity, including ISO 17025 for testing laboratories, ISO 9001 and ISO 14001 for the manufacturing industry, and GLP/GMP and the United States Pharmacopeia (USP) for the pharmaceutical industry.
For HPLC Functions are included for the preparation of buffer solutions used in HPLC. As a result, the operation can be performed accurately and easily, even by non-specialists.
Save Your Operation Equipped with USB as standard. Includes many diverse functions to support users.
Features:- Minimum display: 0.01mg / 0.1mg
- Maximum capacity: 52g to 320g (Depends on model)
- Included built in calibration
- Response time for trace mesaurement reduced to about 2s
- Optional ionizer eliminates static electricity in 1s
- Engineered to resist temperature changes and disturbance.
- High visability EL display
- Waring signal of minimum sample quantity
- Registered sample name or ID can be associated with measurement values
- Specific gravity can be measured with specific gravity measurement kit
Easy-to-Read Organic EL Display (All models)
Because the pixel elements in the organic electroluminescence display emit light, the screen can be seen clearly even in dark locations. Multi-language display capability*2 provides a more intuitive operating interface. A wider viewing angle has also improved the visibility of measurement values, which helps increase the efciency of measuring operations.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]


Built-in High-Performance Ionizer (Optional)
The ionizer eliminates influence of static electricity in 1/10 the time of previous models. Note: Example of typical static electricity removal time (±1000 V --> ±100 V) 1 sec. for STABLO-AP and 10 sec. for STABLO-EX[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_video link="https://youtu.be/WC369euxu1o" align="center" title="AP series"][vc_column_text]Ordering Information:Model | Capacity | Minimum Display | Repeatability (standard deviation) | Linearity | Response Time | Pan size |
AP225W NEW! | 220g | 0.01mg | 0.015mg (to 20g) 0.03mg (to 100g) 0.05mg (to weighing capacity) | 0.1mg | 8s | 91mm |
AP135W | 135g | 0.01mg | 0.05mg | 0.1mg | 8s | 91mm |
AP125WD | 120g/52g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.02mg | 0.2mg/0.05mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP225WD | 220g/102g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.05mg | 0.2mg/0.1mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP124W | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224W | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324W | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124X | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224X | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324X | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124Y | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224Y | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324Y | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |

快速
- 采用新型质量传感器 UniBloc AP,反应速度和稳定性均得以大幅提升。可实现快速稳定的测量。
- 采用新处理方法软件(AP-I系统),提升测量操作感,让您更舒适和自由地使用天平。
可靠
- 消除静电对测量的影响,确保可靠的测量结果。(需要选配件STABLO-AP)
操作简便
- 标准配备USB和RS232C连接器。可同时向打印机和PC输出数据。通过USB主设备(W系列配备),可连接USB存储器、键盘、条形码识别器。
- 采用在黑暗处也可清晰看清屏幕的“有机EL显示器”。
- 支持用户检查天平的功能。选择检查功能,操作界面即显示检查操作步骤。
- 标准配备缓冲溶液的制备模式,样品制备模式,调配配方模式等。
- 安全可靠的用户管理功能
- 符合ISO/GMP/GLP的打印功能
- Labsolutions balance可实现天平称量数据在数据库中的一元化管理
- Labsolutions balance可实现天平称量数据在数据库中的一元化管理
型号 | 量程 | 精度 | 重复性 | 线性 | 平均响应时间 | 称盘尺寸 |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
AP135W | 135g | 0.01mg | 0.05mg | 0.1mg | 8s | 91mm |
AP125WD | 120g/52g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.02mg | 0.2mg/0.05mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP225WD | 220g/102g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.05mg | 0.2mg/0.1mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP124W | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224W | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324W | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124X | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224X | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324X | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124Y | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224Y | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324Y | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |

快速
- 采用新型质量传感器 UniBloc AP,反应速度和稳定性均得以大幅提升。可实现快速稳定的测量。
- 采用新处理方法软件(AP-I系统),提升测量操作感,让您更舒适和自由地使用天平。
可靠
- 消除静电对测量的影响,确保可靠的测量结果。(需要选配件STABLO-AP)
操作简便
- 标准配备USB和RS232C连接器。可同时向打印机和PC输出数据。通过USB主设备(W系列配备),可连接USB存储器、键盘、条形码识别器。
- 采用在黑暗处也可清晰看清屏幕的“有机EL显示器”。
- 支持用户检查天平的功能。选择检查功能,操作界面即显示检查操作步骤。
- 标准配备缓冲溶液的制备模式,样品制备模式,调配配方模式等。
- 安全可靠的用户管理功能
- 符合ISO/GMP/GLP的打印功能
- Labsolutions balance可实现天平称量数据在数据库中的一元化管理
- Labsolutions balance可实现天平称量数据在数据库中的一元化管理
型号 | 量程 | 精度 | 重复性 | 线性 | 平均响应时间 | 称盘尺寸 |
---|---|---|---|---|---|---|
AP135W | 135g | 0.01mg | 0.05mg | 0.1mg | 8s | 91mm |
AP125WD | 120g/52g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.02mg | 0.2mg/0.05mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP225WD | 220g/102g | 0.1mg/0.01mg | 0.1mg/0.05mg | 0.2mg/0.1mg | 2s/8s | 91mm |
AP124W | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224W | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324W | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124X | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224X | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324X | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP124Y | 120g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP224Y | 220g | 0.1mg | 0.1mg | 0.2mg | 2s | 91mm |
AP324Y | 320g | 0.1mg | 0.15mg | 0.3mg | 2s | 91mm |

分析天平ATX/ATY系列
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1378" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fqn504200000065ni-att%2Fc054-e066c.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
- Minimum display: 0.1mg
- Maximum sample capacity: 62g to 320g (Depends on model)
- Superior performance and budgeted balance
- Designed to set large container on the pan up to 91mm diameter.
- Allow internal calibration by pressing keys (ATX Series only)
- External calibration can perform by span calibration
- Easy setting to adjust the desire ratio of stability and response
- Convenient for making multiple measurement of sample and also the total mass
- Compare sample to target values or pass/fail criteria
Model | ATX84 | ATX124 | ATX224 | ATX324 | ATY64 | ATY124 | ATY224 | ATY324 |
Capacity | 82 g | 120 g | 220 g | 320 g | 62 g | 120 g | 220 g | 320 g |
Minimum Display | 0.1 mg | |||||||
Repeatability (Standard Deviation) | ≤0.1 mg | |||||||
Linearity | ±0.2 mg | |||||||
Stabilisation Time*1 | Approx. 3.0 seconds | |||||||
Operating Temperature and Humidity Limits | 5-40°C 20-85%*2 | |||||||
Temperature Coefficient for Sensitivity (10-30°C) | ±2ppm/°C | |||||||
Pan Size (mm) approx. | Φ91 | |||||||
Main Body Dimensions (mm) approx. | 213(W) x 356(D) x 338(H) | |||||||
Main Body Weight (kg) approx. | 6.2 | 6.0 | ||||||
Power requirement | 12V, 1A | |||||||
Internal Calibration | ✔ |

型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(mg) | 重复性(mg) | 线性(mg) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
ATX224 | 220 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATX124 | 120 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATX84 | 82 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY224 | 220 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY124 | 120 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY64 | 62 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |

型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(mg) | 重复性(mg) | 线性(mg) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
ATX224 | 220 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATX124 | 120 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATX84 | 82 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY224 | 220 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY124 | 120 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |
ATY64 | 62 | 0.1 | 0.1 | 0.2 | 2.5 | 91 |

电子精密天平TW/TX/TXB系列
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="539,529" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Ftoploading%2Fqn504200000065zu-att%2Fqn50420000007k36.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
- Mininum display: 0.1g / 0.01g / 0.001g (Depends on model)
- Maximum sample capacity: 320g to 6200g (Depends on model)
- Extremely capable balance with easy to operate key layout
- Expanded Piece Counting function of enter, store and recall up to 5 different samples
- Can be used anywhere with battery power (TXB series only)
- Power will automatically turn off after a fixed or pre-set time
- Sliding glass door windbreak system to assure fine measurement (TX series with 0.001g minimum display)
- Display provides prompts for calibration procedure
- Able to convert into various of units
TX series
Model | TX223L | TX323L | TX423L | TX2202L | TX3202L | TX4202L |
Capacity | 220g | 320g | 420g | 2200g | 3200g | 4200g |
Minimum Display | 0.001g | 0.001g | 0.001g | 0.01g | 0.01g | 0.01g |
Repeatability | 0.001g | 0.01g | ||||
Linearity | ±0.002g | ±0.02g | ||||
Operating Ambient Temperature | 5-40°C | |||||
Temperature Coefficient Sensitivity (ppm/C) | ±3 | |||||
Pan Size (mm) approx. | ø110 | 167(W)×181(D) | ||||
Main Body Dimensions (mm) approx. | 206(W)×291(D)×241(H) | 200(W)×291(D)×80(H) | ||||
Weight (kg) approx. | 3.8kg | 2.8kg | ||||
Power requirement | AC adaptor ( DC12V, 1A ) |
TXC series
Model | TXC323L | TXC623L |
Capacity | 320ct | 620ct |
Minimum Display | 0.001ct | |
Repeatability | 0.001ct | |
Linearity | ±0.002ct | |
Operating Ambient Temperature | 5-40°C | |
Temperature Coefficient Sensitivity (ppm/C) | ±3 | |
Pan Size (mm) approx. | ø80 | |
Main Body Dimensions (mm) approx. | 206(W)×291(D)×241(H) | |
Weight (kg) approx. | 3.8kg | |
Power requirement | AC adaptor ( DC12V, 1A ) |
TXB series
Model | TXB222L | TXB422L | TXB622L | TXB2201L | TXB4201L | TXB6201L | TXB621L | TXB6200L |
Capacity | 220g | 420g | 620g | 2200g | 4200g | 6200g | 620g | 6200g |
Minimum Display | 0.01g | 0.1g | 1g | |||||
Repeatability | 0.01g | 0.1g | 1g | |||||
Linearity | ±0.01g | ±0.02g | ±0.1g | ±0.2g | ±0.1g | ±1g | ||
Operating Ambient Temperature | 10-30°C | |||||||
Temperature Coefficient Sensitivity (ppm/C) | ±15 | ±10 | ±5 | ±15 | ±10 | ±5 | ±20 | |
Pan Size (mm) approx. | ø110 | ø160 | ø110 | ø160 | ||||
Main Body Dimensions (mm) approx. | 199(W)×260(D)×77(H) | |||||||
Weight (kg) approx. | 1.5kg | |||||||
Power requirement | AC adaptor ( DC12V, 1A ) or 6AA batteries |

型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(g) | 重复性(g) | 线性(g) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
TW223L | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TW323L | 320 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TW423L | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX223L | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX323L | 320 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX423L | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX2202L | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TX3202L | 3200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TX4202L | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TWC323L | 320ct/64g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TWC623L | 620ct/124g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXC323L | 320ct/64g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXC623L | 620ct/124g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXB222L | 220 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB422L | 420 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB622L | 620 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB621L | 620 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.1 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB2201L | 2200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.1 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB4201L | 4200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.2 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB6201L | 6200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.2 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB6299L | 6200 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1-2 | 160 |

型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(g) | 重复性(g) | 线性(g) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
TW223L | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TW323L | 320 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TW423L | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX223L | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX323L | 320 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX423L | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1-2.5 | 110 |
TX2202L | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TX3202L | 3200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TX4202L | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2.5 | 167×181 |
TWC323L | 320ct/64g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TWC623L | 620ct/124g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXC323L | 320ct/64g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXC623L | 620ct/124g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.001ct/0.0002g | 0.002ct/0.0004g | 1-2.5 | 80 |
TXB222L | 220 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB422L | 420 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB622L | 620 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB621L | 620 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.1 | 1-2 | 110 |
TXB2201L | 2200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.1 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB4201L | 4200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.2 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB6201L | 6200 | 0.1 | 0. 1 | 0.2 | 1-2 | 160 |
TXB6299L | 6200 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1-2 | 160 |

电子托盘天平UW/UX系列
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1382" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Ftoploading%2Fqn504200000065rm-att%2Fc054-e038e.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
- Minimum display: 0.1g, 0.01g, 0.001g (Depends on model)
- Maximum sample capacity: 220g to 8200g (Depends on model)
- Automatic calibration can perform once ambient temperature variatons detected or at a selected time
- Calibration report can be print with optional electronic printer
- Customized combination of units can be done by user
- Upper and lower limit can be set, display can continually indicate whether the sample is within the range, over range or under range
UW series (with built-in calibration weights)
Model | UW220H | UW420H | UW620H | UW820H | UW1020H | UW2200H | UW4200H | UW6200H | UW420S | UW820S | UW4200S | UW8200S |
Capacity | 220g | 420g | 620g | 820g | 1020g | 2200g | 4200g | 6200g | 420g | 820g | 4200g | 8200g |
Minimum Display | 0.001g | 0.01g | 0.1g | |||||||||
Repeatability | ≤0.001g | ≤0.01g | ≤0.008g | ≤0.08g | ||||||||
Linearity | ±0.002g | ±0.003g | ±0.02g | ±0.01g | ±0.1g | |||||||
Response time | 1.5 - 2.5s | 0.7 - 1.2s | ||||||||||
Pan Size (mm) approx. | 108 x 105 | 170 x 180 | 108 x 105 | 170 x 180 |
UX series (standard model)
Model | UX220H | UX420H | UX620H | UX820H | UX1020H | UX2200H | UX4200H | UX6200H | UX420S | UX820S | UX4200S | UX8200S |
Capacity | 220g | 420g | 620g | 820g | 1020g | 2200g | 4200g | 6200g | 420g | 820g | 4200g | 8200g |
Minimum Display | 0.001g | 0.01g | 0.1g | |||||||||
Repeatability | ≤0.001g | ≤0.01g | ≤0.008g | ≤0.08g | ||||||||
Linearity | ±0.002g | ±0.003g | ±0.02g | ±0.01g | ±0.1g | |||||||
Response time | 1.5 - 2.5s | 0.7 - 1.2s | ||||||||||
Pan Size (mm) approx. | 108 x 105 | 170 x 180 | 108 x 105 | 170 x 180 |

PSC 全自动内校(UW系列)
型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(g) | 重复性(g) | 线性(g) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
UW220H | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW420H | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW620H | 620 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW820H | 820 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW1020H | 1020 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW2200H | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW4200H | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW6200H | 6200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW420S | 420 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UW820S | 820 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UW4200S | 4200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UW8200S | 8200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UX220H | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX420H | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX620H | 620 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX820H | 820 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX1020H | 1020 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX2200H | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX4200H | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX6200H | 6200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX420S | 420 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UX820S | 820 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UX4200S | 4200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UX8200S | 8200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |

PSC 全自动内校(UW系列)
型号 | 量程(g) | 精度(g) | 重复性(g) | 线性(g) | 平均响应时间(S) | 称盘尺寸(mm) |
UW220H | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW420H | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW620H | 620 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW820H | 820 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW1020H | 1020 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UW2200H | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW4200H | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW6200H | 6200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UW420S | 420 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UW820S | 820 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UW4200S | 4200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UW8200S | 8200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UX220H | 220 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX420H | 420 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX620H | 620 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX820H | 820 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX1020H | 1020 | 0.001 | 0.001 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 108×105 |
UX2200H | 2200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.002 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX4200H | 4200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX6200H | 6200 | 0.01 | 0.01 | 0.02 | 1.5-2.5 | 170×180 |
UX420S | 420 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UX820S | 820 | 0.01 | 0.008 | 0.01 | 0.7-1.2 | 108×105 |
UX4200S | 4200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |
UX8200S | 8200 | 0.1 | 0.08 | 0.1 | 0.7-1.2 | 170×180 |

BL Series – Top- loading Balance
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="1384,527" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Ftoploading%2Fqn5042000000663y-att%2Fqn50420000007kb4.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
- Minimum display: 0.01g, 0.001g (Depends on model)
- Maximum sample capacity: 220g to 3200g (Depends on model)
- High resolution balance with quick response
- High stability even the environment is not ideal for precision weighing
- Analog bar graph display able to show remaining weighing capacity
- Protective in-use cover can be added for measurement
- Able to convert into various of units
- Bright LCD display
Model | Capacity | Minimum display | Pan size (mm) | |
BL220H | 220g | 0.001g | 100 x 100 | |
BL320H | 320g | 0.001g | 100 x 100 | |
BL2200H | 2200g | 0.01g | 160 x 124 | |
BL3200H | 3200g | 0.01g | 160 x 124 | |
BL3200HL | 3200g | 0.01g | 160 x 124 | |
BL320S | 320g | 0.01g | 100 x 100 | |
BL620S | 620g | 0.01g | 160 x 124 | |
BL3200S | 3200g | 0.1g | 160 x 124 |

BW-K/BX-K Series- High precision platform Balance
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1386" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fqn50420000006682-att%2Fqn50420000007khw.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
The patented UniBloc (OPF) sensor achieves high-performance, compact size, and durability at the same time. Shimadzu introduced this wire-cut block sensor to high-precision platform balances in 1989. Combination of low-profiled body and large pan is for operator comfort during bulk weighing.
- Minimum display: 1g, 0.1g (Depends on model)
- Maximum sample capacity: 12kg to 52kg (Depends on model)
- Simple structure and overload protection mechanism results in maximum durability.
- Sensitivity guaranteed
- Equipped with built-in calibration weight (BW-K Series only)
- Upper and lower limit can be set, display can continually indicate whether the sample is within the range, over range or under range
BW-K (with built-in calibration weights)
Model | Capacity | Minimum display | Pan size (mm) | |
BW12KH | 12kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BW22KH | 22kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BW32KH | 32kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BW32KS | 32kg | 1g | 345 x 250 | |
BW52KS | 52kg | 1g | 345 x 250 |
BX-K (Standard)
Model | Capacity | Minimum display | Pan size (mm) | |
BX12KH | 12kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BX22KH | 22kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BX32KH | 32kg | 0.1g | 345 x 250 | |
BX32KS | 32kg | 1g | 345 x 250 | |
BX52KS | 52kg | 1g | 345 x 250 |

电子式水分仪MOC-120H
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1388" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fmoisture%2Fqn504200000066a4-att%2Fqn50420000007kq8.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Accurate moisture measurement with new weight sensor: UniBloc
The moisture content of a variety of samples can be measured using an array of drying modes. The drying status can be seen at-a-glance with the fluctuation range display. Active in a variety of fields (cereals, starch, flour, noodles, brewed products, sea foods and marine products, meat products, spices, sweets, dairy products, dried foods, vegetable oils and other food articles; pharmaceuticals; ores; cokes; glass materials; cement; chemical fertilizers; pulp and paper; cotton; various fabrics and other industrial goods); enabling measurement of samples (cereals, foods, and chemical products) under various conditions (powder, particles, paste, and liquid).Large Pan
A large sample pan (130mm diameter) enables a large amount of sample to be placed evenly in a thin layer. This results in accurate and fast measurements with minimal drying non-uniformities.Long-life heater
A mid-wave infrared quartz heater provides effective drying without interference for a wide range of samples. In addition to the excellent drying performance, it offers a long operational life of 20,000 to 30,000 hours.UniBloc sensor
The internal precision weighing balance is engineered with a Shimadzu UniBloc cell. The mechanism provides excellent stability and a long operational life against repeated temperature changes, enabling easy measurements down to 0.001g.Moisture vaporization monitoring
The moisture vaporization rate is monitored and can be visually seen on a bar graph display. This is useful to know as the measurement nears completion. It updates every 30 seconds.Three drying modes besides standard drying mode
Rapid drying mode
Slow drying mode
Step drying mode
Predictive measuring mode
- Minimum display: 0.001g
- Maximum sample capacity: 120g
- Moisture content measurement range: 0.01% to 100%
- Temperature range: 30°C to 180°C
- Designed to set large amount of sample on the pan (1300mm diameter)
- Equipped with mid-wave infrared quartz heater and able to operate up to 30,000 hours
- Moisture vaporization rate is monitored and can be seen on the display
- Sample drying process can be done in 4 ways (Rapid, Slow, Step drying and Standard drying)
Model | MOC-120H (#321-63300-10) |
Measuring method | Heat drying and weight loss |
Sample pan size | 130mm dia |
Minimum display in weighing | 0.001g |
Measurement range of moisture content | 0.01% to 100.00% |
Moisture content minimum display | 0.01% |
Sample capacity | 120g |
Measurement modes | Automatic or Timed ending modes, Standard, Rapid, Slow and Step drying modes, Predictive Measuring mode |
Drying heater | Mid-wave infrared quartz heater |
Setting temperature range | 30 to 200°C by 1°C increments (Sample position temperature) |
Dimensions | 220W × 415D × 190H (mm) |
Weight | 4.5 kg |
Operational temperature and humidity range | 5 to 40°C, 85% RH or lower |
Power requirements | AC 100 to 120 / 220 to 240 V, 640 W maximum |
Standard accessories | Sample pan 2 pcs, Sample pan handler 2 pcs, Aluminum sheet 20 pcs, Spoon, Spatula |
Stored procedures | 10 |

型号(P/N) |
MOC-120H |
(321-63300) |
|
测定方式 | 红外线加热干燥质量测定方式 |
称量盘尺寸 |
30mm |
称量部最小显示值 |
0.001g |
水分率测定范围 |
0.01%~100.00% |
水分率最小显示位 |
0.01% |
最大试样量 |
120g |
测定方式 | 自动停止、时间停止、快速干燥、慢速干燥、分段干燥、预测(比较)测定 |
干燥热源 | 中波长红外线石英加热器 |
温度设定范围 |
30~180℃(步距1℃) |
主机尺寸·重量 |
220W×415D×190H(mm),4.5kg |
工作温湿度范围 |
5~40℃,85%RH以下 |
所需电源 |
AC100~120/220~240V,最大640W |
附件 | 试样盘×2个,盘托、防风具、试样盘夹、铝片×20张 |

型号(P/N) |
MOC-120H |
(321-63300) |
|
测定方式 | 红外线加热干燥质量测定方式 |
称量盘尺寸 |
30mm |
称量部最小显示值 |
0.001g |
水分率测定范围 |
0.01%~100.00% |
水分率最小显示位 |
0.01% |
最大试样量 |
120g |
测定方式 | 自动停止、时间停止、快速干燥、慢速干燥、分段干燥、预测(比较)测定 |
干燥热源 | 中波长红外线石英加热器 |
温度设定范围 |
30~180℃(步距1℃) |
主机尺寸·重量 |
220W×415D×190H(mm),4.5kg |
工作温湿度范围 |
5~40℃,85%RH以下 |
所需电源 |
AC100~120/220~240V,最大640W |
附件 | 试样盘×2个,盘托、防风具、试样盘夹、铝片×20张 |

MOC63u Moisture Analyzer
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4182,4181" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fmoisture%2Fqn5042000000hxro-att%2Fqn5042000001b2dg.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance
Trust the MOC63u for Both Speedy and Accurate Measurements
Moisture ratio measurements are indispensable for quality control and as checks of raw materials in a variety of industries including food products, chemistry, and pharmaceuticals. The MOC63u electronic moisture analyzer is capable of accurate, quick and easy moisture ratio measurements. Just place the sample in the sample pan and close the cover to start the measurement. This instrument can accommodate virtually any sample, and will contribute to enhanced user productivity.[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]Customers in the Food Product Industry








Model | MOC63u (#321-71500-12) | |
Capacity | Max | 60g |
Min | 0.02g | |
Minimum readability | 0.001g | |
0.01/0.1% (Selectable) | ||
Repeatability | 0.15% (2g) 0.05% (5g) 0.02% (10g) | |
Drying Heater | Straight type halogen heater | |
Power | 400W | |
Temperature range setting | 50-200°C (1°C increments) (There is a time restriction when exceeding 180°C.) | |
Display | LCD with backlight | |
Pan size | Ø95mm | |
Dimensions (WxDxH) mm | 202 × 336 × 157 | |
Weight | Approx 4.2kg | |
Operational temperature and humidity range | 5 to 40°C, 85%RH or lower | |
Measurement modes | Standard (Easy start/Automatic end/Timed end) | |
Rapid drying (Easy start/Automatic end/Timed end) | ||
Slow drying (Easy start/Automatic end/Timed end) | ||
Step drying (Easy start/Automatic end/Timed end) | ||
Timer setting | 1-240 minutes or continuous (max 12 hours) | |
Interface | RS-232C (9-pin connector) I/O port | |
USB port | ||
Measurement conditions data memory | 10 | |
Data memory | 100 | |
Temperature calibration kit | Option | |
Standard accessories | Sample pans (3 aluminum pans), pan supporter, windbreak, Heater insulation plate, aluminum pans (50 disposable pans), Sample pan handler, power cable, spare fuses (2), protective display cover, hexagonal wrench |

电子天平打印机EP-110/EP-100
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="1392,1393" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fprinter%2Fn9j25k00000m0utp-att%2Fn9j25k00000m0v72.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Built-In Clock
Enables printing time and date information even with a balance that doesn't have a clock function.Enhanced Support for ISO/GLP
EP-100 can output time/signature information. In addition to this information, EP-110 can output other information based on your demands together with measured values. See samples below for details.OLED Dot Matrix Display (EP-110 only)
Offers easy-to-read, brightly illuminated OLED display.
Automatically Set
Automatically sets the appropriate communication with a balance. An operator doesn't have to worry about its setting.EP-110 Provides further applications
- Pipette calibration Calibrate capacity of pipette and flask
- User-defined calculation Operator can set coefficients (handy for converting result to local unit)
- Tare/Net/Gross weight printing Print out Tare/Net/Gross weight separately
- SUM mode Print out the total values of samples
- Averaging mode Print out the average of samples
- Formulation mode Print out each sample's weight independently when blending samples
- Comparator mode Print out result whether weight of sample is within target range
- Interval printing mode Print out current weight at a regular interval
Model | EP-100 | EP-110 |
Display | - | OLED 128 x 64 Dot Matrix Display |
Protected Date Setting | - | Prevents unintended changes of time and date setting. |
Printing |
Method: 8-pin reciprocating impact dot matrix |
|
Speed: Approx. 1.7 lines/sec. Printer head life; 1 million linesCharacter size; Approx. W1.7 mm × H2.6 mm. | ||
Interface | RS-232 DB9 | |
Power Supply |
AC adapter: Input 100 to 240 V AC, 50/60 Hz; Output 12 V DC /1500 mA |
|
Power consumption: 8 W (while printing)Standby power 0.5 W (when not printing) | ||
Installation Environment | Temperature 5 to 45 °C, humidity 10 to 80 % No condensation | |
Compatible balance models | AU, AT, UW/A95:C102UX, TW/TX, TXB, BW-K/BX-K, ELB, AW/AX/AY series, MOC63u |

- ♦ 内置时钟功能
- ♦ 符合ISO/GMP/GLP法规要求
- ♦ 液晶显示屏(EP-110)
- ♦ 自动设定功能
型号 | EP-100 | EP-110 |
---|---|---|
显示屏 | - | 液晶显示屏(128mmx64mm) |
数据保护功能 | - | 防止意外更改时间或其他参数 |
打印 | 方法:针式打印;速度:约1.7行/秒;打印头寿命:100万行;字体大小:约1.7mm(W)x2.6mm(H) | |
接口 | RS232 D89 | |
电源 | 交流电:AC 100-20/220-240,50/60Hz,DC12,1.5A 功率:8W(打印时);待机功率:1.5W(不打印时) | |
安装环境 | 温度5~45℃ 湿度10~80% |

- ♦ 内置时钟功能
- ♦ 符合ISO/GMP/GLP法规要求
- ♦ 液晶显示屏(EP-110)
- ♦ 自动设定功能
型号 | EP-100 | EP-110 |
---|---|---|
显示屏 | - | 液晶显示屏(128mmx64mm) |
数据保护功能 | - | 防止意外更改时间或其他参数 |
打印 | 方法:针式打印;速度:约1.7行/秒;打印头寿命:100万行;字体大小:约1.7mm(W)x2.6mm(H) | |
接口 | RS232 D89 | |
电源 | 交流电:AC 100-20/220-240,50/60Hz,DC12,1.5A 功率:8W(打印时);待机功率:1.5W(不打印时) | |
安装环境 | 温度5~45℃ 湿度10~80% |

Bucket set for Animal Balance
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Balance
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top" equal_height="yes"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="1395,1396,1397" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes" css_animation="none"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Dedicated software brings quick and reliable results of live animal weighing.
Upon removing the weighed animal, the weight of remaining feces and output are automatically tared off, and the balance presents zero for the next animal. Order a standard balance plus one of the applicable animal bucket sets.Model | Catalog No. | Balance Series | Reduced Capacity (approx.) |
Small Animal Bucket set | 321-62150 | UW/UX (Capacity 2200g or more) | Bottom 110dia, Top 200dia, Height 130 |
Medium-size Animal Bucket set*1 | 321-62545-03 | BX-K | Bottom 305 x 215, Top 377 x 245, Height 215 |
321-62545-04 | BW-K | Bottom 305 x 215, Top 377 x 245, Height 215 | |
Large Animal Bucket set*2 | 321-62545-01 | BX-K (Capacity 22kg or more) | Bottom 335 x 245, Top 445 x 395, Height 345 |
321-62545-02 | BW-K (Capacity 22kg or more) | Bottom 335 x 245, Top 445 x 395, Height 345 |

静电消除器STABLO-AP
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main > Equipment > Balance[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1390" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.shimadzu.com%2Fan%2Fbalance%2Fn9j25k00000on4su-img%2Fstablo-ap.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
STABLO-AP provides reliable measurement by removing static electricity.
- AC corona discharge method enables excellent ion polarity balance
- Wide angle static removal
- High performance maintained over a long period of use
- No inverse charging
- Shimadzu's unique 2-WAY Ionizer: hand-held / on stand
Static Electricity Removal by Ion Irradiation
With the high-frequency AC corona discharge method, Shimadzu’s STABLO-AP ionizer provides a stable ion balance and excellent static removal performance on samples and containers. Precision weighing work becomes remarkably efficient. Electrodes are safely housed inside the unit.
AC Method Produces Excellent Ion Balance
AC method: AC voltage is applied on the discharge needle and a well-balanced mixture of positive/negative ions is emitted in rapid alternation from one electrode. DC method: DC voltage is applied to a couple of electrodes. One is positive and the other is negative. Each electrode emits ions of one polarity only. An effective static removal angle is limited if the two electrodes are distanced. As electrodes deteriorate, initial ion balance is lost.

Applications:
On Stand

Ion Generation Method | AC corona discharge method |
Ion Balance | ±10V |
Effective Static Removal Range | 50 - 400 mm from the outlet |
Static Elimination Time (approx.) | 1 second (Typical value) (from ±1000 V to ±100 V) |
Ozone Concentration | 0.06 ppm |
Electrode Probes | Tungsten (durability: 30,000 hours) |
Weight | Approx. 710 g (Main unit: 395 g, Stand: 315 g) |
Operating Temperature and Humidity | 0 ºC to + 40 ºC, 25 % RH to 85 % RH (non-condensing) |
Rated Electric Power Supply | DC 24 V, 1.0 A |

可大幅提升消除静电效率的静电消除器上市了!
消除称量过程中产生的静电,获得可靠的测量结果。 可有效消除粉末样品、药品包装用纸、容器等产生的静电。- 卓越的静电消除能力!(采用可确实消除静电的AC方式)
- 宽大的离子出口可实现无风快速除电(除电时间仅为原来的1/10)
- 可长期稳定使用,不产生逆带电。
- 设计小巧,可灵活放置。
- 附带岛津特有的2WAY支架,可手持使用。

可大幅提升消除静电效率的静电消除器上市了!
消除称量过程中产生的静电,获得可靠的测量结果。 可有效消除粉末样品、药品包装用纸、容器等产生的静电。- 卓越的静电消除能力!(采用可确实消除静电的AC方式)
- 宽大的离子出口可实现无风快速除电(除电时间仅为原来的1/10)
- 可长期稳定使用,不产生逆带电。
- 设计小巧,可灵活放置。
- 附带岛津特有的2WAY支架,可手持使用。

MAGIO Laboratory Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
MAGIO laboratory circulators

Powerful pump
With an extremely powerful pressure/suction pump with performance values up to 31 l/min or 0.92 bar (pressure) and -0.4 bar (suction), the MAGIO series offers the strongest pump in its class and is therefore perfectly suited for challenging external temperature tasks. To ensure maximum resistance against chemical substances, all wetted parts are made from stainless steel.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
Modern touch display
The high resolution, modern TFT touch display has a multi-lingual user interface and shows all important information at a glance. Three large, predefined main screens clearly display data and graphics with various application priorities. All display functions are easy to operate with a fingertip.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
External temperature control
MAGIO refrigerated circulators are perfect for external temperature tasks thanks to their powerful pumps and wide temperature range. Extensive accessories and excellent dynamics mean that the MAGIO circulators can be modularly and individually adapted to the most challenging applications.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
Simple data exchange
Modern interfaces make easy remote control and practical data management possible as well as allowing integration into process structures. All MAGIO units come with integrated Pt100 connection, USB interface, RS232 and Ethernet. Analog interfaces are optionally available as accessories.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
MAGIO MS Refrigerated / Heating circulator
with extremely powerful pressure/suction pump and intuitive touch display
As with all circulators from the MAGIO range, the refrigerated circulators stand out thanks to their premium quality, high performance and intuitive operation. The devices offer extra strong pressure and suction pumps, thus fulfilling the highest demands for temperature control of external applications. Whether in basic research, material testing or technical systems – the MAGIO refrigerated circulators offer high-tech solutions for high customer requirements.Model | MAGIO MS-600F | MAGIO MS-601F | MAGIO MS-900F | MAGIO MS-1000F |
---|---|---|---|---|
Order No. | 9 032 704 | 9 032 705 | 9 032 706 | 9 032 707 |
Working temperature range (°C) | -35 ... +200.0 | -35 ... +200.0 | -38 ... +200.0 | -50 ... +200.0 |
Temperature stability (°C) | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 |
Cooling capacity (kW) | 0.6 | 0.6 | 0.9 | 1 |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 | 2 | 2 | 2 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 |
Model | MAGIO MS-310F |
---|---|
Order No. | 9 032 713 |
Working temperature range (°C) | -30.0 ... +200.0 |
Temperature stability (°C) | +/-0.01 |
Cooling capacity (kW) | 0.33 |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 16 ... 31 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.24 ... 0.92 |
MAGIO MS and MX Bridge Mounted Circulators
with extremely powerful pump and intuitive touch display
MAGIO bridge mounted circulators combine high temperature control performance with maximum flexibility. The adjustable bridge means that the circulators can be used with bath tanks up to a filling volume of 100 liters.Model | MAGIO MS-Z | MAGIO MX-Z |
---|---|---|
Order No. | 9 032 201 | 9 033 201 |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20.0 ... +300.0 | +20.0 ... +300.0 |
Temperature stability (°C) | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 | 3 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 |
MAGIO MS / MX Heating Circulators
with extremely powerful pumps, intuitive touchscreen displays
Like all circulators in the MAGIO range, the heating circulators are characterised by premium quality and high performance combined with intuitive usability. The devices offer extra powerful pressure and suction pumps to meet the most challenging demands for temperature control of external applications. Samples can also be temperature controlled in the internal bath of the high-quality, insulated and closed bath tank.Model | MAGIO MS-BC4 | MAGIO MX-BC6 | MAGIO MX-BC12 | MAGIO MX-BC26 |
---|---|---|---|---|
Order No. | 9 032 504 | 9 033 506 | 9 033 512 | 9 033 526 |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20.0 ... +300.0 | +20.0 ... +300.0 | +20.0 ... +300.0 | +20.0 ... +300.0 |
Temperature stability (°C) | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 | +/-0.01 |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 | 3 | 3 | 3 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 | 16 ... 31 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 | 0.24 ... 0.92 |

Heating Immersion Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
with attachment clamp for any bath tank up to 50 liters filling volume
JULABO immersion circulators for controlling temperature in any bath tank up to 50 liters. These units are equipped with a bath attachment clamp for wall thicknesses up to 26 mm. Alternatively, the circulator may be fastened to a laboratory stand. The clamp makes it easy to install the circulator onto an existing bath tank. Parts that are immersed in bath liquid are constructed of high quality stainless steel or synthetic material. Common applications include controlling the temperature of samples, temperature testing of food or luxury articles, materials testing, and evaluation, adjustment, and calibration or thermometers and thermal switches.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Corio C" tab_id="HIC_CorioC"][vc_column_text]The new generation of laboratory circulators
The CORIO C Immersion Circulator is the basic model of the CORIO circulator portfolio. The bath attachment clamp is included in delivery and facilitates mounting of the circulator on any bath tank up to 30 liters.
Your advantages
- Precise temperature control
- For internal standard applications
- For bath tanks with a max. filling volume of 30 liters
- Bright, white, easy to read display
- Very quiet
- Easy operation
- Class I (NFL) according to DIN 12876-1
Order No. | 9011000 |
Model | CORIO C |
Category | Heating Immersion Circulators |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20 ... +100 |
Temperature stability (°C) | ±0.03 |
Setting / display resolution | 0.01 – 0.1 °C |
Temperature Display | LED |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 |
Circulation capacity flow rate (l/min) | 6 |
Circulation capacity pressure (bar) | 0.1 |
Ambient temperature | 5...40 °C |
Dimensions W x L x H (cm) | 13.2 x 16 x 36.2 |
Weight (kg) | 1.9 |
Cooling coil | optional |
Usable immersion depth (cm) | 16.6 |
The new generation of laboratory circulators
In addition to the advantages of the CORIO C Circulator, the CORIO CD Immersion Circulator can be equipped with an optional pump set for temperature control of external applications.
Your advantages
- Precise temperature control
- For internal and external applications (accessories required)
- For bath tanks with a max. filling volume of 50 liters
- Bright, white, easy to read display
- Very quiet
- Easy operation
- Easy pump change-over between internal and external circulation
- USB connection
- Class III (FL) according to DIN 12876-1
Order No. | 9012000 |
Model | CORIO CD |
Category | Heating Immersion Circulators |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20 ... +150 |
Temperature stability (°C) | ±0.03 |
Setting / display resolution | 0.01 – 0.1 °C |
Temperature Display | LED |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 15 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.35 |
Ambient temperature | 5...40 °C |
Dimensions W x L x H (cm) | 13.2 x 16 x 36.2 |
Weight (kg) | 2.6 |
Cooling coil | optional |
Usable immersion depth (cm) | 16.6 |
Laboratory Circulators with an expanded working temperature range up to +200 °C
In addition to the advantages of the CORIO C Circulator, the CORIO CD and CP Immersion Circulator can be equipped with an optional pump set for temperature control of external applications.
Your advantages
- Precise temperature control
- For internal and external applications (accessories required)
- For bath tanks with a max. filling volume of 50 liters
- Immersion depth: 7.5 ... 16.5 cm
- Bright, white, easy-to-read display
- Very quiet
- Easy handling
- Easy change-over from internal to external circulation and vice versa
- pump capacity, infinitely adjustable
- USB interface
- R232 interface
- Early warning system for low liquid level
- Class III (FL) according to DIN 12876-1
Order No. | 9013000 |
Model | CORIO CP |
Category | Heating Immersion Circulators |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20 ... +200 |
Temperature stability (°C) | ±0.02 |
Setting / display resolution | 0.01 – 0.1 °C |
Temperature Display | LED |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 8 ... 27 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
Viscosity max. (cSt) | 50 |
Ambient temperature | 5...40 °C |
Dimensions W x L x H (cm) | 13.2 x 16 x 36.2 |
Weight (kg) | 2.5 |
Cooling coil | optional |
Usable immersion depth (cm) | 16 |
New temperature control technology for demanding applications
DYNEO DD heating circulators for internal and external applications are equipped with closed bath tanks. The tanks are well insulated and include a coil for counter-cooling. An integrated drain tap makes emptying the tank safe and clean. The multilingual 3.5-inch color display and unique rotary knob provide for straightforward and intuitive operation.
Your advantages
- Flexible installation options
- For internal and external applications
- Powerful and infinitely adjustable pressure pump
- Flow rate 23 l/min, pressure 0.6 bar
- Easy switching between internal and external circulation
- Large color TFT display, multilingual interface
- Central rotary knob (controller) simplifies operation
- Integrated programmer for 8 x 60 program steps
- Integrated external Pt100 connection
- USB port
- RS232 interface or analog interfaces (optional)
Order No. | 9021000 |
Order No. with RS232 Option | 9021000.D |
Order No. with analog Option | 9021000.A |
Model | DYNEO DD |
Category | Heating Immersion Circulators |
Working temperature range (°C) | +20 ... +200 |
Temperature stability (°C) | ±0.01 |
Setting / display resolution | 0.01 °C |
Temperature Display | 3.5" TFT Display |
Heating capacity (kW) | 2 |
Pump capacity flow rate (l/min) | 8 ... 23 |
Pump capacity flow pressure (bar) | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
Viscosity max. (cSt) | 50 |
Ambient temperature | 5...40 °C |
Dimensions W x L x H (cm) | 13.2 x 16 x 35.5 |
Weight (kg) | 2.5 |
Cooling coil | optional |
Usable immersion depth (cm) | 16 |

Open Heating Bath Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
for internal temperature applications
Open heating bath circulators are designed for internal applications in the circulator bath. The models on this page are equipped with bath tanks made of Polycarbonat or stainless steel. Available accessories include a variety of test tube racks, immersion-height adjustable platforms and cooling coils. The circulator can be removed for easy cleaning of the bath tanks.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="CORIO" tab_id="OHBC_Corio"][vc_column_text]The new generation of laboratory circulators for routine work and standard tasks

Your advantages
- Models for internal applications
- Bright, white, easy to read display
- Very quiet
- Integrated drain screw (except B5)
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump pressure (bar) | Circulation capacity flow rate (l/min) |
(°C) | (°C) | |||||
9011405 | CORIO C-B5 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011413 | CORIO C-B13 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011417 | CORIO C-B17 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011419 | CORIO C-B19 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011427 | CORIO C-B27 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011305 | CORIO C-BT5 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011309 | CORIO C-BT9 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011319 | CORIO C-BT19 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |
9011327 | CORIO C-BT27 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 0.1 | 6 |

Heating Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
for external and internal temperature applications up to +300 °C with stainless steel bath tanks and pump connections
JULABO circulators with stainless steel bath tanks are suitable for both internal and external temperature control. They have greater power for larger and open systems, making them ideal for external temperature control. Smaller objects may be inserted directly into the circulator's bath at the same time. Models are available with a variety of bath sizes and other functional characteristics. Accessories like Pt100 sensors, heat transfer liquid, tubing, and adapters are available to facilitate connection to external systems. An integrated cooling coil enables temperature control below or near the ambient temperature.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="CORIO" tab_id="HC_CORIO"][vc_column_text]Laboratory Circulators with an expanded working temperature range up to +200 °C
In addition to the advantages of the CORIO C Circulator, the CORIO CD and CP Immersion Circulator can be equipped with an optional pump set for temperature control of external applications.
Your advantages
- Precise temperature control
- For internal and external applications (accessories required)
- For bath tanks with a max. filling volume of 50 liters
- Immersion depth: 7.5 ... 16.5 cm
- Bright, white, easy-to-read display
- Very quiet
- Easy handling
- Easy change-over from internal to external circulation and vice versa
- pump capacity, infinitely adjustable
- USB interface
- R232 interface
- Early warning system for low liquid level
- Class III (FL) according to DIN 12876-1
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure (bar) |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | ||||
9012504 | CORIO CD-BC4 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012506 | CORIO CD-BC6 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012512 | CORIO CD-BC12 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012526 | CORIO CD-BC26 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9013504 | CORIO CP-BC4 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013506 | CORIO CP-BC6 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013512 | CORIO CP-BC12 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013526 | CORIO CP-BC26 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
New temperature control technology for demanding applications
DYNEO DD heating circulators for internal and external applications are equipped with closed bath tanks. The tanks are well insulated and include a coil for counter-cooling. An integrated drain tap makes emptying the tank safe and clean. The multilingual 3.5-inch color display and unique rotary knob provide for straightforward and intuitive operation.
Your advantages
- Suitable for internal and external applications
- Powerful and infinitely adjustable pressure pump
- Flow rate 22 l/min, pressure 0.6 bar
- Easy switching between internal and external circulation
- Large color TFT display, multilingual interface
- Central rotary knob (controller) simplifies operation
- Integrated programmer for 8 x 60 program steps
- Integrated external Pt100 connection
- USB port
- RS232 interface or analog interfaces
- Bath cover included with delivery
- Integrated drain makes emptying liquid easy and safe.
- High-quality thermal insulation of the bath tank
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure (bar) |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | ||||
9021504 | DYNEO DD-BC4 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021506 | DYNEO DD-BC6 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021512 | DYNEO DD-BC12 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021526 | DYNEO DD-BC26 | +20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
Heating Circulator with stainless-steel bath tank for internal and external temperature applications
JULABO Heating Circulators with stainless steel bath tanks are mainly used for internal and external temperature tasks. The new range of these models now have increased capacities, allowing for temperature application of larger external systems, as well as open systems. Simultaneous temperature applications of smaller objects can also be carried out directly in the internal bath of the circulator. Models from the TopTech and HighTech Series’ are available with different bath sizes and features. Accessories for these units include test tube racks, bath covers etc. An integrated cooling coil is provided for temperature applications at near ambient or just below.
Your advantages
- VFD COMFORT DISPLAY
- Keypad for setpoints, warning/safety values and menu functions
- ICC (Intelligent Cascade Control), self-optimizing temperature control
- ATC3 3-Point-Calibration
- Pt100 External sensor connection for measurement and control
- SMART PUMP, electronically adjustable pump stages
- Early warning system for low liquid level (DBGM 203 06 059.8)
- Adjustable high temperature cut-out, visible via display
- RS232 interface for online communication
- Integrated programmer for 10 program steps
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure (bar) |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | ||||
9212504 | HE-4 | +20 ... +250 | ±0.01 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312504 | HL-4 | +20 ... +250 | ±0.01 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9252506 | SE-6 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9252512 | SE-12 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9252526 | SE-26 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352506 | SL-6 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352512 | SL-12 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352526 | SL-26 | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |

Bridge Mounted Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
with extendable bridge for bath tanks up to 100 liters filling volume
JULABO bridge mounted circulator with extendable stainless steel bridge. The adjustable bridge permits use of the circulator with a wide variety of bath tanks. This model is suitable for both internal and external temperature control tasks. It has the power to control the temperature of even large bath tanks up to 100 L. An integrated cooling coil enables temperature control below or near the ambient temperature.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="HighTech" tab_id="BMC_HighTech"][vc_column_text]Sophisticated models for demanding applications
Bridge mounted circulator with extendable bridge for any bath tank up to 100 liters JULABO bridge mounted circulator with extendable bridge made of stainless steel for any bath tanks. For internal and external temperature applications. The model offers high pump and heating capacities for temperature control of large baths up to 100 liters. Including a built-in cooling coil for counter-cooling with tap water.
Your advantages
- VFD COMFORT DISPLAY
- Keypad for setpoints, warning/safety values and menu functions
- ICC (Intelligent Cascade Control), self-optimizing temperature control
- ATC3 3-Point-Calibration
- Pt100 External sensor connection for measurement and control
- SMART PUMP, electronically adjustable pump stages
- Early warning system for low liquid level (DBGM 203 06 059.8)
- Adjustable high temperature cut-out, visible via display
- RS232 interface for online communication
- Integrated programmer for 10 program steps
- Expandable bridge from 31 to 66 cm
- Built-in cooling coil
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure (bar) |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | ||||
9252218 | SE-Z | +20 ... +300 | ±0.01 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |

Heating Circulators with Open Bath
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
For internal and external temperature applications with transparent or stainless steel bath tanks and pump connections
JULABO open heating bath circulators with bath tanks made of stainless steel, Plexiglas, or Makrolon are designed for internal and external temperature applications. They are primarily used for internal temperature control directly within the bath tank. External closed systems may be connected via the integrated pump connections. Models are available with a variety of bath sizes and other functional characteristics. A variety of bath inserts for laboratory glassware, bath covers, and adjustable floors are available as accessories. Common applications include temperature control of measurement cells, photometers, and samples; heating of glass flasks; and temperature testing of food, luxury articles, and materials.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="CORIO" tab_id="HCOB_Corio"][vc_column_text]The new generation of laboratory circulators for routine work and standard tasks
The Open Heating Bath Circulators of the new CORIO series feature high-quality bath tanks made of stainless steel and pump connections.
Your advantages
- Models for internal and external applications
- Bright, white, easy to read display
- Very quiet
- Easy pump change-over between internal and external circulation
- USB connection
- High-quality bath tanks made of stainless steel
- Integrated drain screw (except B5)
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure (bar) |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | ||||
9012405 | CORIO CD-B5 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012413 | CORIO CD-B13 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012417 | CORIO CD-B17 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012419 | CORIO CD-B19 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012427 | CORIO CD-B27 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012433 | CORIO CD-B33 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012439 | CORIO CD-B39 | +20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012305 | CORIO CD-BT5 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012319 | CORIO CD-BT19 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012327 | CORIO CD-BT27 | +20 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |

Refrigerated – Heating Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
for working temperatures from -50 °C to +200 °C
JULABO Refrigerated and Heating Circulators are suitable for temperature application to external systems with simultaneous operation in the bath tank. Models in different performance classes are available. The units provide high heating/cooling capacities to ensure rapid heat-up and cool-down times. With ‚Active Cooling Control' to +200 °C. ‚FP‘ models offer proportional cooling control to ensure energy-saving performance and to reduce heat generation to the environment. Convenient cleaning of dust by removable venting grid. Some models have a handle or castors to allow easy transport. All models provide a drain port on the front for conveniently draining the bath fluid. Typical applications: Temperature applications to external, closed systems, such as for example photometers, refractometers, viscometers, etc. For simultaneous application to small objects in the circulator bath.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="CORIO" tab_id="RHC_CORIO"][vc_column_text]The new generation of laboratory circulators for routine work and standard tasks
Refrigerated / Heating Circulators of the new CORIO series distinguish themselves with a great price-to-performance ratio. They are ideal for all standard tasks and routine work in laboratories and industry.
Your advantages
- Models for internal and external applications
- Bright, white, easy to read display
- Very quiet
- Easy pump change-over (internal and external circulation)
- External pump connections (M16x1)
- USB connection
- Space-saving cooling coil design yields more usable space in the bath tank
- Bath lid and drain tap included
- Removable ventilation grid
- Refrigeration unit without side vents
- Class III (FL) according to DIN 12876-1
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9012701 | CORIO CD-200F | -20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.22 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012702 | CORIO CD-201F | -20 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.22 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012703 | CORIO CD-300F | -25 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.31 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012704 | CORIO CD-600F | -35 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.6 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012705 | CORIO CD-601F | -40 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.6 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012706 | CORIO CD-900F | -40 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.9 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012707 | CORIO CD-1000F | -40 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 1 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9012708 | CORIO CD-1001F | -38 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 1 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9013701 | CORIO CP-200F | -20 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.2 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013702 | CORIO CP-201F | -20 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.2 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013703 | CORIO CP-300F | -30 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.3 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013704 | CORIO CP-600F | -35 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.6 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013705 | CORIO CP-601F | -35 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.6 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013706 | CORIO CP-900F | -38 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 0.9 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9013707 | CORIO CP-1000F | -50 ... +200 | ±0.03 | 1 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
9012708 | CORIO CP-1001F | -38 ... +100 | ±0.03 | 1 | 2 | 8 ... 27 | 0.1 ... 0.7 |
New temperature control technology for demanding applications
DYNEO DD refrigerated circulators have a wide working temperature range. Refrigerated circulators are suitable for both internal and external applications. The multilingual 3.5-inch color display and unique rotary knob provide for straightforward and intuitive operation. Pump capacity is 22 l/min with pressure of 0.6 bar. The cooling machines operate precisely and reliably even at elevated ambient temperatures up to +40 °C.
Your advantages
- Powerful cooling machines
- Suitable for internal and external applications
- Optimized cooling coil design saves space in the bath tank
- Powerful and infinitely adjustable pressure pump
- Flow rate 22 l/min, pressure 0.6 bar
- Easy switching between internal and external circulation
- Large color TFT display, multilingual interface
- Central rotary knob (controller) simplifies operation
- Integrated programmer for 8 x 60 program steps
- Integrated external Pt100 connection
- USB port
- RS232 interface or analog interfaces (optional)
- Bath cover included with delivery
- Integrated drain makes emptying liquid easy and safe.
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9021701 | DYNEO DD-200F | -20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.2 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021702 | DYNEO DD-201F | -20 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.2 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021703 | DYNEO DD-300F | -25 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.3 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021704 | DYNEO DD-600F | -35 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.6 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021705 | DYNEO DD-601F | -35 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.6 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021706 | DYNEO DD-900F | -38 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.9 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021707 | DYNEO DD-1000F | -50 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 1 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
9021708 | DYNEO DD-1001F | -38 ... +100 | ±0.01 | 1 | 2 | 8 ... 23 | 0.1 ... 0.6 |
The powerful upper class unit for demanding applications.
JULABO Refrigerated & Heating Circulators for heating and cooling are suitable for external temperature tasks and for temperature applications directly in the bath. A model from three different series’ with different capacities can be selected. Powerful circulating pump systems and high heating and cooling capacities guarantee short heat-up and cool-down times. The inevitable dust accumulation that occurs in refrigeration systems is solved by means of an easily removed venting grid, which allows for easy cleaning. Depending on the model, the units are equipped with handles or castors for an easy transportation. All models have a drain tap on the front allowing the fluid to be drained easily. The compact assembly of each unit enables space to be saved in the laboratory.
Your advantages
- VFD COMFORT DISPLAY
- Keypad for setpoints, warning/safety values and menu functions
- ICC (Intelligent Cascade Control), self-optimizing temperature control
- ATC3 3-Point-Calibration
- Pt100 External sensor connection for measurement and control
- SMART PUMP, electronically adjustable pump stages
- Adjustable pressure and suction pump
- Early warning system for low liquid level (DBGM 203 06 059.8)
- Adjustable high temperature cut-out, visible via display
- RS232 interface for online communication
- Optional: analogue interfaces
- Integrated programmer for 10 program steps
- Active Cooling Control
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9212625 | F25-HE | -28 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.26 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312625 | F25-HL | -28 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.26 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9212632 | F32-HE | -35 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.45 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312632 | F32-HL | -35 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.45 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312633 | F33-HL | -30 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.5 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9212634 | F34-HE | -30 ... +150 | ±0.01 | 0.45 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312618 | FP35-HL | -35 ... +150 | ±0.01 | 0.45 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9212640 | FP40-HE | -40 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.68 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312640 | FP40-HL | -40 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.68 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9212650 | FP50-HE | -50 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.9 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312650 | FP50-HL | -50 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.9 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9212651 | FPW50-HE | -50 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.9 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312651 | FPW50-HL | -50 ... +200 | ±0.01 | 0.9 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |

Cryo-Compact Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
for working temperatures from -40 °C to +200 °C
The new CF series offers compact refrigerated/heating circulators. With small overall dimensions the units can even be placed on a very small surface or within a complex installation. All models offer a heating capacity of 2 kW and safety class 3 according to DIN12876-1. The maximum ambient temperature of +40°C as well as a ventilation air cooling allow installing the units very closely side by side with other units or directly under a fume hood. Furthermore all the models feature pump connections for external temperature applications and a bath opening for temperature control of small objects directly in the circulator bath. Wetted parts are made of high quality stainless steel or plastic. The instruments provide a reliable Microprocessor electronics with high temperature stability as well as warning and safety functions.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Economy" tab_id="CCC_Economy"][vc_column_text]The first choice for routine and straightforward laboratory applications from -40°C to 150°C
Cryo-Compact Circulator for internal and external temperature applications The CF series offers compact refrigerated/heating circulators. With small overall dimensions the units can even be placed on a very small surface or within a complex installation. All models offer a heating capacity of 2 kW and classification 3 according to DIN12876-1. The maximum ambient temperature of +40°C as well as a ventilation air cooling allow installing the units very closely side by side with other units or directly under a fume hood. Furthermore all the models feature pump connections for external temperature applications and a bath opening for temperature control of small objects directly in the circulator bath. Wetted parts are made of high quality stainless steel or plastic. The instruments provide a reliable Microprocessor electronics with high temperature stability as well as warning and safety functions.
Your advantages
- Ergonomic design and easy operation
- Small overall dimensions for lowest space requirement
- Splash-proof keypad
- Large, bright LED temperature display
- Precise PID temperature control
- RS232 interface for PC connection
- Adjustable high temperature cut-off
- Classification 3 according to DIN12876-1
- Pump connections for external temperature applications
- Bath opening for temperature control of small objects in the bath
- Front drain
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9400330 | CF30 | -30 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.32 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
9400340 | CF40 | -40 ... +150 | ±0.03 | 0.47 | 2 | 15 | 0.35 |
The top class for demanding applications of all types.
Cryo-Compact Circulator for internal and external temperature applications The new CF series offers compact refrigerated/heating circulators. With small overall dimensions the units can even be placed on a very small surface or within a complex installation. All models offer a heating capacity of 2 kW and classification 3 according to DIN12876-1. The maximum ambient temperature of +40°C as well as a ventilation air cooling allow installing the units very closely side by side with other units or directly under a fume hood. Furthermore all the models feature pump connections for external temperature applications and a bath opening for temperature control of small objects directly in the circulator bath. Wetted parts are made of high quality stainless steel or plastic. The instruments provide a reliable Microprocessor electronics with high temperature stability as well as warning and safety functions.
Your advantages
- Ergonomic design and easy operation
- Small overall dimensions for lowest space requirement
- Splash-proof keypad
- Bright VFD display and interactive LCD dialog display
- Highly precise ICC cascade temperature control
- RS232/RS485 interface for PC connection
- Electronically adjustable pump stages
- External Pt100 sensor connection
- Integrated programmer with 6x60 program steps
- Early warning system for low liquid level
- 3-point calibration
- TCF Temperature Control Features
- Adjustable high temperature cut-off
- Classification 3 according to DIN12876-1
- Pump connections for external temperature applications
- Bath opening for temperature control of small objects in the bath
- Front drain
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9400331 | CF31 | -30 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 0.32 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9400341 | CF41 | -40 ... +200 | ±0.02 | 0.47 | 2 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |

Ultra-Low Refrigerated-Heating Circulators
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
For working temperatures from -91 °C to +200 °C
JULABO Ultra-Low Refrigerated Circulators for heating and cooling. The units are suitable for external temperature applications with simultaneous operation in the bath tank. The units provide particularly high heating and cooling capacities for rapid heat-up and cool-down times even for large volume, external systems. ‚FP‘ models offer proportional cooling control to ensure energy-saving performance and to reduce heat generation to the environment. Models with the designation ‚W‘ are water-cooled. With handle or castors to allow easy transport. With drain port for conveniently draining the bath fluid. The units offer an improved insulation to prevent ice-formation and have a filling level display. Typical applications: Temperature applications to jacketed reaction vessels, autoclaves, miniplant installations, kilo labs, freezing point determination, calibration at low temperatures, petroleum testing, etc.[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="TopTech" tab_id="ULRHC_TopTech"][vc_column_text]Upper middle class with ext. Pt100 sensor connection
Ultra-low Refrigerated Circulator with 2-stage cascade-cooling JULABO Ultra-Low Refrigerated Circulators for heating and cooling are suitable for external temperature tasks. Powerful circulating pump systems and high heating and cooling capacities guarantee short heat-up and cool-down times. ACC ‘Active Cooling Control‘ provides active cooling control across the whole temperature range. An energy saving feature with only minor loss of heat is provided by the proportional cooling capacity control in the ‘FP’ refrigeration units. The inevitable dust accumulation that occurs in refrigeration systems is solved by means of an easily removed venting grill, which allows for easy cleaning. The units are equipped with handles or castors for an easy transportation. All models have a drain tap on the front allowing the fluid to be drained easily. Additionally the instruments are equipped with an improved insulation to help avoid ice-formation, and have a visual liquid level display.
Your advantages
- VFD COMFORT DISPLAY
- Keypad for setpoints, warning/safety values and menu functions
- PID3 cascade temperature control
- ATC3 3-Point-Calibration
- Pt100 External sensor connection for measurement and control
- SMART PUMP, electronically adjustable pump stages
- Early warning system for low liquid level (DBGM 203 06 059.8)
- Adjustable high temperature cut-out, visible via display
- RS232 interface for online communication
- Integrated programmer for 10 program steps
- Active Cooling Control
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9162670 | F70-ME | -70 ... +100 | ±0.02 | 0.34 | 1.3 | 11-16 | 0.23-0.45 |
9162681 | F81-ME | -81 ... +100 | ±0.02 | 0.45 | 1.3 | 11-16 | 0.23-0.45 |
9162689 | FP89-ME | -90 ... +100 | ±0.02 | 1 | 1.3 | 11-16 | 0.23-0.45 |
Superior models for most demanding applications
JULABO Ultra-Low Refrigerated Circulators for heating and cooling are suitable for external temperature tasks. Powerful circulating pump systems and high heating and cooling capacities guarantee short heat-up and cool-down times. ACC ‘Active Cooling Control‘ provides active cooling control across the whole temperature range. An energy saving feature with only minor loss of heat is provided by the proportional cooling capacity control in the ‘FP’ refrigeration units. The inevitable dust accumulation that occurs in refrigeration systems is solved by means of an easily removed venting grill, which allows for easy cleaning. The units are equipped with handles or castors for an easy transportation. All models have a drain tap on the front allowing the fluid to be drained easily. Additionally the instruments are equipped with an improved insulation to help avoid ice-formation, and have a visual liquid level display.
Your advantages
- VFD COMFORT DISPLAY
- LCD DIALOG DISPLAY backlit for convenient interactive operation
- Keypad for setpoints, warning/safety values and menu functions
- ICC (Intelligent Cascade Control), self-optimizing temperature control
- TCF Temperature Control Features to optimize the control behaviour
- ATC3 3-Point-Calibration
- Pt100 External sensor connection for measurement and control
- SMART PUMP, electronically adjustable pump stages
- Early warning system for low liquid level (DBGM 203 06 059.8)
- Adjustable high temperature cut-out, visible via display
- RS232/RS485 interface for online communication
- Integrated programmer for 6 x 60 program steps
- Connections for solenoid valve and HSP booster pump
- Proportional cooling control
- Active Cooling Control
- Proportional cooling control
Order No. | Model | Working temperature range | Temperature stability | Cooling capacity at 20°C (kW) | Heating capacity (kW) | Pump capacity flow rate | Pump pressure |
(°C) | (°C) | (l/min) | (bar) | ||||
9312681 | F81-HL | -81 ... +100 | ±0.02 | 0.45 | 1.3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352795N | F95-SL | -95 ... +0 | ±0.05 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 | |
9352751 | FP51-SL | -51 ... +200 | ±0.05 | 2 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352752 | FP52-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352752N | FP52-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352752N150 | FP52-SL-150C | -60 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352755 | FP55-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 5.2 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352755N | FP55-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 5.2 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352755N150 | FP55-SL-150C | -60 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 5.2 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9312689 | FP89-HL | -90 ... +100 | ±0.02 | 1 | 1.3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352790 | FP90-SL | -90 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352790N | FP90-SL | -90 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352790N150 | FP90-SL-150C | -90 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352753 | FPW52-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352753N | FPW52-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352753N150 | FPW52-SL-150C | -60 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 3 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352756 | FPW55-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 5.5 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352756N | FPW55-SL | -60 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 5.5 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352756N150 | FPW55-SL-150C | -60 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 5.5 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352791 | FPW90-SL | -90 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352791N | FPW90-SL | -90 ... +100 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352791N150 | FPW90-SL-150C | -90 ... +150 | ±0.05 | 1.8 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352793 | FPW91-SL | -91 ... +100 | ±0.2 | 4.5 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352793N | FPW91-SL | -91 ... +100 | ±0.2 | 4.5 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |
9352796N | FW95-SL | -95 ... +0 | ±0.05 | 3 | 22-26 | 0.4-0.7 |

MKFT 系列 | 高低温交变气候箱 用于温度快速变化并带有湿度控制和超低温
Special features
- Temperature range: -70 °C to 180 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 98 % RH
- Integrated water-storage tank, 20 liters
- 4 zero-voltage relay contacts that can be activated via MCS controller
- Programmable condensation protection for test material
- Heated viewing window with LED interior lighting
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
MKFT 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKFT 240 | 228 | 1115x1940x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKFT 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
MKFT 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKFT 240 | 228 | 1115x1940x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKFT 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

MKT 系列 | 高低温交变气候箱 用于温度快速变化并带有超低温
{:en}
Special features
- Temperature range: -70 °C to 180 °C
- 4 zero-voltage relay contacts that can be activated via MCS controller
- Programmable condensation protection for test material
- Heated viewing window with LED interior lighting
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
MKT 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKT 240 | 228 | 1115x1940x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKT 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |
重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
MKT 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKT 240 | 228 | 1115x1940x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKT 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

MKF 系列 | 高低温交变气候箱 用于温度快速变化并带有湿度控制
- Temperature range: -40 °C to 180 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 98 % RH
- Integrated water-storage tank, 20 liters (Models 115, 240, 720)
- 4 zero-voltage relay contacts that can be activated via MCS controller
- Programmable condensation protection for test material
- Heated viewing window with LED interior lighting
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
MKF 56 | 60 | 732x1445x832 | 400x420x348 |
MKF 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKF 240 | 228 | 1115x1715x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKF 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

重要特性
可选容积型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
MKF 56 | 60 | 732x1445x832 | 400x420x348 |
MKF 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MKF 240 | 228 | 1115x1715x925 | 735x700x443 |
MKF 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

MK 系列 | 高低温交变气候箱 用于温度快速变化
- Temperature range: -40 °C to 180 °C
- Programmable condensation protection for test material
- Heated viewing window with LED interior lighting
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
MK 56 | 60 | 740x1225x740 | 402x402x330 |
MK 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MK 240 | 228 | 1115x1715x925 | 735x700x443 |
MK 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

重要特性
可选容面型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
MK 56 | 60 | 740x1225x740 | 402x402x330 |
MK 115 | 115 | 980x1725x865 | 600x480x400 |
MK 240 | 228 | 1115x1715x925 | 735x700x443 |
MK 720 | 734 | 1580x2005x1140 | 1200x1020x600 |

KBWF 系列 | 生长箱 带光照及湿度调节功能
{:en}
Special features
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 80 % RH
- Humidity regulation with capacitative humidity sensor and vapor humidification
- Positionable illumination cassettes, each with 5 fluorescent tubes
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Door heating
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KBWF 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBWF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |
重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
KBWF 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBWF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

KBW 系列 | 生长箱 带光照功能
{:en}
Special features
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Positionable illumination cassettes, each with 5 fluorescent tubes
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Door heating
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KBW 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBW 400 | 400 | 925x1950x805 | 650x1270x485 |
KBW 720 | 698 | 1250x1925x890 | 970x1250x576 |
重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
KBW 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBW 400 | 400 | 925x1950x805 | 650x1270x485 |
KBW 720 | 698 | 1250x1925x890 | 970x1250x576 |

KMF 系列 | 恒温恒湿箱 扩大的温度/湿度范围
- Temperature range: -10 °C to 100 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 98 % RH
- Humidity regulation with capacitive humidity sensor and vapor humidification
- Inner chamber made of stainless steel
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KMF 115 | 102 | 880x1050x650 | 600x483x351 |
KMF 240 | 247 | 930x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KMF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

重要特性
可选容积型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 ( mm) |
KMF 115 | 102 | 880x1050x650 | 600x483x351 |
KMF 240 | 247 | 930x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KMF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

KBF LQC 系列 | 恒温恒湿箱 带符合 ICH 要求的光照和光剂量控制
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 80 % RH
- Humidity regulation with capacitive humidity sensor and vapor humidification
- Illumination cassettes with ICH-compliant UV/Vis light source
- Independent light-dose control of UV-A and visible light with spherical sensors
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KBF LQC 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF LQC 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

重要特性
可选容积型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
KBF LQC 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF LQC 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

KBF P 系列 | 恒温恒湿箱 带符合 ICH 要求的光照
{:en}
Special features
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 80 % RH
- Humidity regulation with capacitive humidity sensor and vapor humidification
- Illumination cassettes with ICH-compliant UV/Vis light source
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KBF P 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF P 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |
重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
KBF P 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF P 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |

KBF 系列 | 恒温恒湿箱 温度/湿度范围大
{:en}
Special features
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 80 % RH
- Humidity regulation with capacitive humidity sensor and vapor humidification
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Inner chamber made of stainless steel
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KBF 115 | 102 | 880x1050x650 | 600x483x351 |
KBF 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |
KBF 1020 | 1020 | 1250x1925x1145 | 976x1250x836 |
重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
KBF 115 | 102 | 880x1050x650 | 600x483x351 |
KBF 240 | 247 | 925x1460x800 | 650x785x485 |
KBF 720 | 700 | 1250x1925x890 | 973x1250x576 |
KBF 1020 | 1020 | 1250x1925x1145 | 976x1250x836 |

KBF1020-Large Scale Climatic Chamber
- Internal volume: 1020L
- Temperature range: 0 °C to 70 °C
- Humidity range: 10 % to 80 % RH
- line™ preheating chamber technology
- Intuitive touchscreen controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Tight-sealing inner door made of safety glass (ESG)
- Inner chamber made of stainless steel
- Door heating

重要特性
{:}
Smeg Basic line GW0160 60cm glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Basic Line>GW0160[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW0160 is a glassware washer designed to work with one to two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620mm (168L gross). Possibility for washing and thermic disinfection (up to 85°C).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2627" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW0160" tab_id="GW0160"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW0160 (art. 860384)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 85 °C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 7 default
- microprocessor electronic control
- active thermodynamic drying
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 304 stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW0160-1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW0160A (art. 860692)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- additional booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P14060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
GW0160S (art. 860386)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 85 °C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 7 default
- microprocessor electronic control
- active thermodynamic drying
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 304 stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW0160S1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW0160SA (art. 860693)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
Technical Features
GW0160 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 7 |
Customisable programs | 0 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 85°C |
Accurancy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and neutralizing agent dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser and 1 pump for neutralizing agent |
Detergent level sensor | no |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | no |
Programme editing | no |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | no |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | no |
Cycle storage | no |
Cycle file download | no |
Download archivio cicli | no |
Program editing | no |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW on three-phase version, 2,3 kW on single-phase version |
STEAM CONDENSER | no |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 600x600x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 72 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 304 |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 2,8 kW 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW0160 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW0160 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM40 WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE TILL 49 CM IN HEIGHT







CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2751" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2656" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2635" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40S
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2659" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2789" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4B
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing. Suitable for washing of 5 x 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2849" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 x U6260 spigots and 8 x special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2664" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2633" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16S
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16I: same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2850" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2851" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2631" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes. Suitable for washing of 10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes. Suitable for washing 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2660" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2790" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier for washing 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2852" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2753" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2663" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2853" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200 (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing . Suitable for washing 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2854" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
基础系列 – GW2145 – 45cm宽洗瓶机
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Basic Line>GW2145[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW2145 is a glassware washer with slim dimensions,designed to work with either one to two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 380 x 480 x 580mm (105 litres) and has the capability for washing and thermic disinfection (up to 95°C).
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2572" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW2145" tab_id="GW2145"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW2145 (art. 860454)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- active thermodynamic drying
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing 1 additional peristaltic pump
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 450 x 620 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 370 x 480 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 3,3 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- Schuko plug 16 A - 250 V included
- upper and lower trolleys D-CS1 and D-CS2 included
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW2145A (art. 860698)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- P12145 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- TOP45I - BUILT-IN TOP 45 CM
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
Technical Features
GW2145 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 9 |
Customisable programs | 6 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensor in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and neutralizing agent dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser, 1 liquid pumps and 1 pump as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Programme editing | yes, using 6 customisable programs |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 200 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 3,3 kW Max |
STEAM CONDENSER | no |
DIMENSIONS LXDXH MM | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 450x620x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 370x480x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 56 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 3,3 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW2145
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="2678" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms where supports for all types of glassware can be located (beakers, test tubes, flasks, plates and various other materials). Photo: D-CS1 upper basket: SB9 straight line support for beakers and flasks to the left, SB14 spring tine support to the right. Each support occupies ½ the rack for machines with width of 45 cm. D-CS2 lower basket: SB28 universal spring support for beakers and flasks, standard on 60-cm models, occupying all the lower base but cannot be positioned on the upper rack.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for all types of glassware. Photo: D-CS1 upper basket: it is fitted with 2 supports equipped with compartments (CP192 and CP222) to wash test tubes. D-CS2 lower basket: SB9 insert for beakers and flasks to the left, SB14 spring support to the right. Each support occupies ½ the rack for machines with width of 45 cm to optimise the load on the rack.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="2679" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="2680" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration is suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware of different sizes Photo: The LM24 is secured to the lower D-CS2 basket using two special fastenings. This solution is suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware of different sizes with a capacity of 24 items and a maximum height of glassware of 500 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW2145 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM24 UNIVERSAL WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE - 24 POSITIONS







D-CS1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]D-CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2891" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2612" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM24
PIPETTES/FLASK WASHING CARRIER Mixed stainless-steel flask/pipette carriage with 12+12 positions, suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with the following nozzles: 4 x U6240, 2 x U6220, 2 x U4160, 2 x U4140, 2 x U3110, 12 x LB40. Maximum glassware height of 490 mm. Positioning on the D-CS2 rack lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM24
FLASK WASHING INSERT Universal 24-position stainless steel flask washer, suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with the following nozzles: 6 x U6240, 5 x U6220, 6 x U4160, 5 x U4140, 2 x U3110. Positioning on the D-CS2 rack lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2608" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2611" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM22S
FLASK WASHING INSERT Universal 22-position stainless steel flask washer, suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Fitted with the following nozzles: 12 x U4140, 5 x U3110, 5 x U390. Positioning on the D-CS1 rack upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM46
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER– 46 POSITIONS Suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 220 mm in height. Upper basket insert equipped with the following nozzles: 12 x U4140 (140 mm), 6 x U390 (90 mm), 6 x U3110 (110 mm). Lower basket insert equipped with the following nozzles: 6 x U4140 (140 mm), 2 x U390 (90 mm), 2 x U3110 (110 mm), 2 x U6220 (220 mm), 2 x U6240 (240 mm), 2 x U6260 (260 mm), 2 x U4180 (160 mm), 6 x U4160 (160 mm), 1 x UC6 (curved).Made of stainless steel. Positioned on the rack levels of D-CS1 and D-CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2610" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications [/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]{:}{:zh}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]您的位置: 主页>仪器>洗瓶机[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
规格
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW2145" tab_id="GW2145"][vc_column_text]GW2145 (目录号 860454) - 实验室洗瓶机
- 洗涤温度高至95°C - 抗菌热消毒
- 程序: 9个预设 + 6个自定义
- 可编程微处理电子控制器
- RS232接口,连接打印机或者电脑
- 主动热力干燥
- 碱性洗涤粉剂分配器
- 酸性中和剂蠕动泵
- 可安装1个附加蠕动泵
- AISI 316不锈钢洗涤内腔
- AISI 304不锈钢外壳
- 2层独立洗涤层,带伸缩导轨
- 外部尺寸 LxDxH: 450 x 620 x 850mm
- 内腔尺寸 LxDxH: 370 x 480 x 570mm
- 软水器含盐传感器
- 冷水和软化水连接
- 电子门锁系统,保障用户安全
- 电源: 1/N/PE 230V - 50Hz - 3.3kW 最大
- 60Hz版本可选
- 包括Schuko插头16 A/250 V
- 包括上层(D-CS1)和下层(D-CS2)洗涤推车
其他可选型号
GW2145A (目录号 860698) - 实验室洗瓶机
- GW2145标准规格
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
可选配件
- P12145 - 液体洗涤剂蠕动泵
- PAD1 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2R - PAD2 继电器套件
- PAD2X - 不锈钢增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2X-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水,60Hz
- TOP45I - 嵌入式安装顶盖, 45cm
- WD-LS3060 - 洗涤剂液位传感器
- WD-PRINTE - 外置打印机
常用洗涤推车,篮子和支架
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM24 UNIVERSAL WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE - 24 POSITIONS















Technical Features
GW2145 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 9 |
Customisable programs | 6 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensor in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and neutralizing agent dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser, 1 liquid pumps and 1 pump as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Programme editing | yes, using 6 customisable programs |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
WATER SUPPLY | |
(PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 200 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 3,3 kW Max |
STEAM CONDENSER | no |
DIMENSIONS LXDXH MM | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 450x620x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 370x480x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 56 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 3,3 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Smeg Basic Line GW1160 60cm glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Basic Line>GW1160[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW1160 is a glassware washer designed to work on either one or two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620 mm (168l gross). Possibility for washing and thermic disinfection (up to 95°C).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2749" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW1160" tab_id="GW1160"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW1160 (art. 860335)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- active thermodynamic drying
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW1160-1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW1160A (art. 860694)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW1160C (art. 860337)LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW1160CA (art. 860695)LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P14060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- P34060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR CAUSTIC SODA
- P44060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
GW1160S (art. 860336)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- active thermodynamic drying
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing one additional peristaltic pump
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW1160S1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW1160SA (art. 860696)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW1160SC (art. 860326)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH STEAM CONDENSER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW1160SCA (art. 860697)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P34060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR CAUSTIC SODA
- P44060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
Technical Features
GW1160 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 9 |
Customisable programs | 6 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 2 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Programme editing | yes, using 6 customisable programs |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW on three-phase version, 2,3 kW on single-phase version |
STEAM CONDENSER | optional |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 600x605x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 74 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 2,8 kW 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW1160 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW1160 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM20 UNIVERSAL WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROWNECKEDGLASSWARE - 24 POSITIONS







CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2751" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2656" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2635" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40S
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2659" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2789" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4B
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing. Suitable for washing five 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2849" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 U6260 spigots and 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2664" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2633" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16S
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16I: same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2850" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2851" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2631" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes. Suitable for washing 10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes. Suitable for washing 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2660" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2790" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier for washing 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2852" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2753" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2663" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2853" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200 (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing. Suitable for washing 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2854" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Basic line GW4060 60cm w/drying system glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Basic Line>GW4060[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW4060 is a glassware washer designed to work with either one or two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620 mm (168l gross). Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2638" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW4060" tab_id="GW4060"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW4060 (art. 860296)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW4060-1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4060A (art. 860704) - LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW4060C (art. 860186)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW4060CA (art. 860705)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM AND STEAM CONDENSER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AF4060 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P14060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- P34060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR CAUSTIC SODA
- P44060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
GW4060S (art. 860297)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing one additional peristaltic pump
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW4060S1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4060SA (art. 860706)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW4060SC (art. 860280)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW4060SCA (art. 860707)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AF4060 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- AS4060 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P34060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR CAUSTIC SODA
- P44060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
Technical Features
GW4060 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 9 |
Customisable programs | 6 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 2 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Programme editing | yes, using 6 customizable programs |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes |
Drying heating element | 0,8 kW |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW on three-phase version, 2,3 kW on single-phase version |
STEAM CONDENSER | yes |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 600x605x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 77 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 2,8 kW 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW4060 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW4060 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM40DS WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE TILL 49CM IN HEIGHT



CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2651" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20DS
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40DS
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2640" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2896" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40SDS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80DS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2897" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2898" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4BDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of five 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2900" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 U6260 spigots and 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2901" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2902" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16SDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16IDS (not shown in the photo): same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2650" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2903" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum with drying system connection. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2667" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2642" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2669" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4DS
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing and drying of 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2904" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2649" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2641" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2905" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100DS
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200DS (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40DS
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2906" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Basic line GW4190 90cm w/drying system glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Basic Line>GW4190[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW4190 is a glassware washer designed to work from one to two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620mm (168l gross). Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter. Integrated compartment for the detergents.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2647" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW4190" tab_id="GW4190"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW4190 (art. 860351)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to printer or PC
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 4 x 5 liters tanks
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW4190-1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4190A (art. 860711)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW4190C (art. 860353)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW4190CA (art. 860712)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
-
- AF4060 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- AS4190 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P14060 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- P14190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- P34190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P44190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TANKBSK - UPPER LEVEL CAN HOLDER BASKET
- TOP90IB - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS4190 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINT9 - PANEL PRINTER
GW4190S (art. 860352)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 9 default + 6 custom
- microprocessor programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to printer or PC
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for acid liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing one additional peristaltic pump
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 4 x 5 liters tanks
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 600 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max
- single phase version available: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 2,8 kW max (GW4190S1)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4190SA (art. 860713)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW4190SC (art. 860354)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW4190SCA (art. 860714)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM AND STEAM CONDENSER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- AF4060 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- AS4190 - AQUA STOP WATER LEAK KIT
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- FLUX4060 - DOSING CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- P14190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID DETERGENT
- P34190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P44190 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD1 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2R - PAD2 RELAY KIT
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TANKBSK - UPPER LEVEL CAN HOLDER BASKET
- TOP90IB - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- TRACELOG - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS4190 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINT9 - PANEL PRINTER
Technical Features
GW4190 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 9 |
Customisable programs | 6 |
Display with segments and communication | yes, 4 digits |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 2 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 30 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Programme editing | yes, using 6 customizable programs |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes |
Drying heating element | 0,8 kW |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW on three-phase version, 2,3 kW on single-phase version |
STEAM CONDENSER | optional |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 900x605x853 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 105 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 1/N/PE 230V ~ 50Hz 2,8 kW 3/N/PE 400V ~ 50Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW4190 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW4190 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LPV40DS WASHING SOLUTION FOR 40 PIPETTES



CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2651" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20DS
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40DS
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2640" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2896" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40SDS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80DS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2897" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2898" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4BDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of five 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2900" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 U6260 spigots and 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2901" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2902" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16SDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16IDS (not shown in the photo): same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2650" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2903" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum with drying system connection. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2667" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2642" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2669" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4DS
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing and drying of 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2904" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2649" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2641" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2905" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100DS
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200DS (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40DS
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2906" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
高级系列 – GW3060 – 60cm宽洗瓶机
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Professional Line>GW3060[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW3060 is a glassware washer designed to work with either one or two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620 mm (168l gross). Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C)[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW3060BX" tab_id="GW3060BX"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW3060BX (art. 860141)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- active thermodynamic drying
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 3 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW3060BXA (art. 860699)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW3060BXC (art. 860241)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW3060BXCA (art. 860700)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW3060S (art. 860189)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- active thermodynamic drying
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW3060SA (art. 860702)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW3060SC (art. 860210)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
GW3060SCA (art. 860703)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW3060P (art. 860190)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER - PETROL
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- active thermodynamic drying
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- peristaltic pump for caustic soda solution
- peristaltic pump for anti-foam additive
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 600 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- spare parts kit for petrol
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW3060PA (art. 860701)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER - PETROL
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- B6040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 60 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T6040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 60 CM MACHINES
- TOP60I - BUILT-IN TOP 60 CM
- WD-LANE - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
Technical Features
GW3060 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | 3 microprocessors + 1 (optional communication card) |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 10 (expandable to 50) |
Backlit graphic LCD display | 128 x 64 pixels |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 3 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 80 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish, Turkish and Polish |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Waste water separation solenoid valve control | optional |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW |
STEAM CONDENSER | optional |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 600x640x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 86 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V ~ 50Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW3060 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW3060 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM40 WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE TILL 49 CM IN HEIGHT







CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2751" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2656" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2635" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40S
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2659" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2789" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4B
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing. Suitable for washing five 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2849" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 U6260 spigots and 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2664" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2633" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16S
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16I: same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2850" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2851" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2631" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes. Suitable for washing10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes. Suitable for washing 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2660" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2790" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier for washing 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2852" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2753" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2663" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2853" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200 (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing. Suitable for washing 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2854" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]{:}{:zh}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]您的位置: 主页>仪器>洗瓶机[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
规格
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW3060BX" tab_id="GW3060BX"][vc_column_text]GW3060BX (目录号: 860141)
- 洗涤温度高至95°C抗菌热消毒
- 程序:20个预设+10个自定义
- 3个可编程微处理电子控制器
- RS232接口,连接打印机或者电脑
- 128×64像素屏幕显示信息
- 主动热力干燥
- 碱性洗涤粉剂分配器
- 酸性中和剂蠕动泵
- 可安装最多3个附加蠕动泵
- AISI316不锈钢洗涤内腔
- AISI304不锈钢外壳
- 2层独立洗涤层,带伸缩导轨
- 外部尺寸LxDxH:600x640x850mm
- 内腔尺寸LxDxH:525x490x570mm
- 软水器含盐传感器
- 冷水,热水和软化水连接
- 电子门锁系统,保障用户安全
- 电源:3/N/PE400V50Hz7kW最大(可转换为1/N/PE230V)
- 60Hz版本可选
- 没有洗涤推车
其他可能的配置
GW3060BXA (目录号: 860699)
- GW3060BX标准规格
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
GW3060BXC (目录号: 860241)
- GW3060BX标准规格
- 高效蒸汽冷凝器,冷水接入
GW3060BXCA (目录号: 860700)
- GW3060BX标准规格
- 高效蒸汽冷凝器,冷水接入
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
可选配件
- ADU - 通用液体添加剂蠕动泵
- B6040L - 不锈钢底座带锁,用于60cm宽机器
- IC5090 - 电导率传感器检查洗涤质量
- IRCP - 吊顶喷洒臂
- PAD - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2X - 不锈钢增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2X-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水,60Hz
- T6040 - 不锈钢框架用于60cm宽机器
- TOP45I - 嵌入式安装顶盖, 60cm
- WD-LAN60 - 数据通信卡
- WD-LS3060 - 洗涤剂液位传感器
- WD-PRINTE - 外置打印机
- WDTRACE - 远程控制与可追溯软件
- WD-VDS - 双排水阀
GW3060S (目录号: 860189)
- 洗涤温度高至95°C - 抗菌热消毒
- 程序: 20个预设 + 10个自定义
- 3个可编程微处理电子控制器
- RS232接口,连接打印机或者电脑
- 128×64像素屏幕显示信息
- 主动热力干燥
- 液体洗涤剂蠕动泵
- 酸性中和剂蠕动泵
- 可安装最多2个附加蠕动泵
- AISI 316不锈钢洗涤内腔
- AISI 304不锈钢外壳
- 2层独立洗涤层,带伸缩导轨
- 外部尺寸 LxDxH: 600 x 640 x 850mm
- 内腔尺寸 LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570mm
- 软水器含盐传感器
- 冷水,热水和软化水连接
- 电子门锁系统,保障用户安全
- 电源: 3/N/PE 400V - 50Hz - 7kW 最大(可转换为1/N/PE 230V)
- 60Hz版本可选
- 没有洗涤推车
其他可能的配置
GW3060P (目录号: 860190)
- GW3060S标准规格
- 碱性液体蠕动泵
- 消泡剂蠕动泵
- 石油类洗涤套件
GW3060PA (目录号: 860701)
- GW3060S标准规格
- 碱性液体蠕动泵
- 消泡剂蠕动泵
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
- 石油类洗涤套件
GW3060SA (目录号: 860702)
- GW3060S标准规格
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
GW3060SC (目录号: 860210)
- GW3060S标准规格
- 高效蒸汽冷凝器,冷水接入
GW3060SCA (目录号: 860703)
- GW3060S标准规格
- 高效蒸汽冷凝器,冷水接入
- 增压泵,用于没有压力软化水
可选配件
- ADU - 通用液体添加剂蠕动泵
- B6040L - 不锈钢底座带锁,用于60cm宽机器
- IC5090 - 电导率传感器检查洗涤质量
- IRCP - 吊顶喷洒臂
- PAD - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水,60Hz
- PAD2X - 不锈钢增压泵用于没有压力软水
- PAD2X-60 - 增压泵用于没有压力软水,60Hz
- T6040 - 不锈钢框架用于60cm宽机器
- TOP60I - 嵌入式安装顶盖, 60cm
- WD-LANE - 数据通信卡
- WD-LS3060 - 洗涤剂液位传感器
- WD-PRINTE - 外置打印机
- WDTRACE - 远程控制与可追溯软件
- WD-VDS - 双排水阀
Common Use Trolleys, Baskests and Racks - GW3060 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LM40 WASHING SOLUTION FOR NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE TILL 49 CM IN HEIGHT







Technical Features
GW3060 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | 3 microprocessors + 1 (optional communication card) |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 10 (expandable to 50) |
Backlit graphic LCD display | 128 x 64 pixels |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 3 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 80 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish, Turkish and Polish |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Waste water separation solenoid valve control | optional |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
WATER SUPPLY | |
(PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW |
STEAM CONDENSER | optional |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 600x640x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 86 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V ~ 50Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Smeg Professional line GW4090 90cm w/drying system glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Professional Line>GW4090[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW4090 is a glassware washer designed to work from one to two independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 530x510x620mm (168L gross). Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter. Integrated compartment for the detergents.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2666" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW4090" tab_id="GW4090"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW4090 (art. 860139)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% dop
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 2 x 5 liters tanks or 4 x 2 liters tanks of capacity
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4090A (art. 860236)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
GW4090C (art. 860191)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser with cold water injection
GW4090CA (art. 860709)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- standard equipment
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TOP90I - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- WD-LANI - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS5090 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW4090BXC (art. 860314)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM AND STEAM CONDENSER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- high efficiency steam condenser Ecoslim, with cold water injection
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 3 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 2 x 5 liters tanks or 4 x 2 liters tanks of capacity
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4090BXCA (art. 860708)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM AND STEAM CONDENSER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TOP90I - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- WD-LANI - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS5090 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW4090P (art. 860634)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% dop
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- peristaltic pump for caustic soda solution
- peristaltic pump for anti-foam additive
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 2 x 5 liters tanks or 4 x 2 liters tanks of capacity
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- spare parts kit for petrol
- without trolleys
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW4090PA (art. 860710)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER
- standard equipment
- booster pump for non-pressure demineralized water
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TOP90I - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- WD-LANI - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS5090 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW4090BXP (art. 860637)
LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER WITH DRYING SYSTEM AND STEAM CONDENSER
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 10 custom
- n. 3 microprocessors programmable electronic control
- serial port RS232 for connection to external printer or PC
- 128 x 64 pixel graphics display for different languages messages
- forced hot air drying system with air filter 98% DOP
- alkaline powder detergent dispenser
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- peristaltic pump for caustic soda solution
- peristaltic pump for anti-foam additive
- washing chamber and internal door in AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel 2 x 5 liters tanks or 4 x 2 liters tanks of capacity
- n. 2 independent washing levels through telescopic guides
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 640 x 850 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 525 x 490 x 570 mm
- incorporated water softener with salt sensor
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- electronic door lock system for user safety
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 7 kW max (switchable to single-phase 230 V)
- 60 Hz version available
- spare parts kit for petrol
- without trolleys
Machine optionals
- ADU - UNIVERSAL PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- B9040L - STAINLESS STEEL PLINTH FOR 90 CM MACHINES WITH LOCK
- IC5090 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- IRCP - CEILING SPRAY ARM
- PAD - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- T9040 - STAINLESS STEEL FRAME FOR 90 CM MACHINES
- TOP90I - BUILT-IN TOP 90 CM
- WD-LANI - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS5090 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTE - EXTERNAL PRINTER
- WDTRACE - REMOTE CONTROL AND TRACEABILITY SOFTWARE
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
Technical Features
GW4090 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | 3 microprocessors + 1 (optional communication card) |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 10 (expandable to 50) |
Backlit graphic LCD display | 128 x 64 pixels |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 1 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. 1 powder dispenser,1 pump for neutralizing agent and 3 other pumps as optional |
Detergent level sensor | optional |
Safety lock | yes, with electromagnetic release and automatic opening |
Safety devices | safety thermostats, door interlock |
Alarm display | 80 |
Troubleshooting menu | yes, using PC connection |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish, Turkish and Polish |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Waste water separation solenoid | optional |
valve control | yes |
Storage of data for 250 most recently run programs | yes |
RS232 serial port for PC connection | yes |
RS232 serial port for printer | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes |
Drying heating element | 2,5 kW |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
Water softener incorporated | yes |
Recirculation pump | 400 l/min |
WATER HEATING | |
Electrical | 6,3 kW |
STEAM CONDENSER | optional |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 900x640x850 (830) |
Inside (gross) | 530x510x620 |
Net weight (Kg) | 110 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V ~ 50Hz 7,0 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 50 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration - GW4090 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2682" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO SPRAYING LEVELS This configuration has two washing levels with spray arms for different types of glassware. Photo: CS1-1 upper basket: it is fitted with RC1/2 net in the right side for the support of various glass items. On the left side: test tube accessory. CS2 lower basket: SB28 insert on the right and SB30 on the left for washing beakers, flasks, plates and various other materials.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE MIXED INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one mixed injection washing level suitable for washing narrow-necked glassware and pipettes. Photo: LPM2020: this system allows simultaneously washing narrownecked glassware (flasks, beakers, round-bottom flasks) and 20 pipettes.Specific carriers for laboratories which clean many different types of glassware at the same time.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2683" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2684" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one injection washing level suitable for washing narrownecked glassware. Photo: LM40: universal injection carrier as it optimises washing of narrow-necked glassware of different sizes. It has a capacity of 40 items and can wash both large items and small flasks or bottles.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Accessories - GW4090 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestions"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]LPM2010DS MIXED WASHING SOLUTION FOR TEST TUBES,PIPETTES AND NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE -20 +10 POSITIONS



CS1-1
UPPER LEVEL BASKET Basic upper basket with sprayer. Suitable for glassware treatment.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CS2
LOWER LEVEL BASKET
Basic lower basket. Suitable for glassware treatment.
.
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2831" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Inserts for flask beakers and cylinders" tab_id="Insert_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2832" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB9
9 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and cylinders of max. 100 ml and funnels. Dimensions: W x D x H = 420 x 145 x 160 mm An insert for 14 positions is also available (SB14). Dimensions: W x D x H = 422 x 146 x 184 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB15
15 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets of 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 115 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2833" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2834" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB28
28 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers and flasks. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity for 16 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 1000 ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 185 mm[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB30
30 POSITION INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing beakers of any size. For use in combination with standard CS1-1 and CS2 baskets and LM20 insert. It has a capacity of 30 items and is made of stainless steel. Recommended for flasks with a capacity of up to 500ml. Dimensions: W x D x H = 400 x 195 x 150 mm An insert for 25 positions is also available (SB25).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2835" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Test tube and small objects inserts" tab_id="insert_b"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2836" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK1
1-LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions.level Dimensions: L x D x H 450 x 450 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: entire washer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CSK2
½ LEVEL SMALL GLASSES AND OBJECTS INSERT It is suitable for washing glasses and objects of small dimensions. Dimensions : L x D x H 450 x 225 x 55mm, mesh 5 x 5mm Space needed: half of a washer level[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2837" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2838" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “CP”
¼ LEVEL TEST TUBE INSERT Compartment suitable for test tubes up to 160. Accessory composed by 3 compartments and a lid. Different sizes depending on the test tubes model. Space needed: 1/4 of a washer level. CP105: test tubes up to 75 mm in height CP132: test tubes up to 105 mm in height CP192: test tubes up to 165 mm in height CP222: test tubes up to 200 mm in height[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle insert" tab_id="insert_c"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2839" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB50
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 56 50 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 46 mm - h 87 mm. PB100 (not in photo) suitable for holding 32 100 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 56 mm - h 100 mm. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB500
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 21 500 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL32 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 86 mm - h 177 mm. PB250 (not in photo) suitable for holding 25 250 ml widenecked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 70 mm - h 138 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2840" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2668" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PB1000
BOTTLE INSERT Suitable for holding 16 1000 ml wide-necked bottles (screw cap GL45 ISO4796 or ground cap DIN 12038 or non-standard cap). Max. bottle size: diam. 101 mm - h 225 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Plate and slide inserts" tab_id="insert_d"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2841" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]PV105
SLIDES INSERT Microscope slide insert made of stainless steel. Suitable for positioning 105 standard microscope slides. Dimensions l x d x h = 220x143x60 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL6
PLATE INSERT It is suitable for washing up to Olympus-type plate for optical recognition of the blood unit. Hinged lid included. Dimensions l x d x h = 485x145x80 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2842" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2843" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL9
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, it is suitable for washing chromatographic plates. Capacity of 9 items. It takes up 1/2 the space of a standard basket.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SL18
CHROMATOGRAPHIC PLATES INSERT Made of stainless steel, suitable for washing 20x20 standard chromatographic plates. Capacity of 18 items. The guides are shaped in such a way that the support points are outside the working surface.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2844" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Various accessories" tab_id="various"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PD"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS PETRI DISH INSERT PD70S - 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD100S - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the upper level CS1-1. PD70I 40 items, 50-70 mm positioned on the lower level CS2. PD100I - 38 items, 70-120 mm positioned on the lower level CS2.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2845" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2846" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES "PF"
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS MESHES PF1/2, ½ space of CS2 or CS1-1 PF1, whole CS1-1 PF2, whole CS2[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SA3
DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS HOLDING NETS RC1 net covering a whole carrier, RC1/2 net covering ½ carrier, RC1/4 net covering 1/4 carrier[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2847" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2848" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SERIES “U”
SPIGOTS OF DIFFERENT DIMENSIONS Injection spigots available in the following versions: - spigot for 6% and 12% butyrometers - Nylon spigot for pipettes - Spigots for glassware with the following heights: 90, 110, 140, 160, 180, 220, 240, 260 mm. Suitable as spare parts on carriers already in use or to equip customizable carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Injection carrier for narrow neck glassware" tab_id="injection_a"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2651" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM20DS
UNIVERSAL FLASK WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height. Fitted with 20 nozzles and half the carrier space is free for mixed glassware suitable for a 1⁄2 basket accessory. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40DS
UNIVERSAL NARROWNECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 490 mm in height, flasks, round-bottom flasks and graduated cylinders of various sizes. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2640" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2896" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM40SDS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 40 spigots with the same height. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM80DS
UNIVERSAL NARROW-NECKED GLASSWARE WASHING CARRIER Stainless-steel carrier for washing and drying narrow-necked glassware up to 225 mm in height. Carrier with 80 spigots with the same height. Positioned on two levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2897" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Bottle washing carrier" tab_id="bottlecarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2898" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB4BDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 2 x 10 L bottles or 4 x 5 L bottles. Fitted with 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LBT5DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for large glass items washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of five 5-litre bottles (diam. 180 x h.500mm, max neck diameter 80 mm). Fitted with 5 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2661" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2900" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB8DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 8 bottles of maximum 50 cm in height. Fitted with 8 U6260 spigots and 8 special spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 450mm) or graduated cylinders (diam. max. 101 mm - h 495 mm). Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2901" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2902" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB16SDS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 16 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 101 mm, h 250mm). Positioned on the upper level. LB16IDS (not shown in the photo): same carrier for the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB32DS
BOTTLE WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing large glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 32 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml, max. diam. 101 mm, H.245 mm. Positioned on 2 levels.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2650" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2903" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB1-20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR BOTTLE OR DRUM Stainless steel carrier for washing universal large glass items and suitable for washing one large bottle and/or drum with drying system connection. Bottle maximum dimensions diameter 300 x h. 350 mm. Positioned on lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="Mixed washing carrier" tab_id="mixedcarrier"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2667" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2010DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS, PIPETTES AND TEST TUBES Stainless steel carrier for washing flasks, pipettes and test tubes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 10 pipettes up to 55 cm + 20 narrow-necked glass items + ¼ free space to be filled with a CP series test tube basket. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPM2020DS
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR FLASKS AND PIPETTES Stainless steel carrier for mixed washing of flasks and pipettes with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying 20 pipettes up to 550 mm in height and 20 narrow-necked glassware with a maximum height of 49 cm. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2642" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2669" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LR4DS
REACTORS WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel trolley for washing and drying four 3/5-way reactors of maximum 3 litres or up to 12 narrow-necked glass items. Fitted with 20 U6260 nozzles. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LT20DS
WASHING CARRIER FOR FISCHER BOTTLES Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing and drying of 12 Fischer bottles and graduated cylinders with a maximum height of 55 cm. 6 positions for injection washing of narrow-necked glassware. Fitted with 18 spigots. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2904" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2649" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPV40DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying volumetric pipettes up to 55 cm in length. 20 positions for pipettes of 55 cm in height and 20 positions for pipettes and/or flasks of 45-49 cm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LPT100DS
PIPETTES WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for washing and drying 100 pipettes with a capacity of 1 to 20 ml and a height up to 450 mm. The pipette washing disc is fitted into the carrier to allow fast loading and unloading access.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2641" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2905" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]KP100DS
TAPERED AND CYLINDRICAL TEST TUBE CARRIER Stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing of tapered and cylindrical test tubes by internal injection. It has a maximum capacity of 100 test tubes. Positioned on the upper washing level. KP200DS (not shown in the photo): same carrier on two washing levels with a maximum capacity of 200 test tubes.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LB40DS
BUTYROMETER WASHING CARRIER Stainless steel carrier for butyrometer washing with drying system connection. Suitable for washing and drying of 40 butyrometers. Specify the type of butyrometer in the order. Positioned on the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2906" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Professional line GW6290 large dimension glassware washers
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Large Capacity>GW6290[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW6290 is a glassware washer designed to work from one to three independent and flexible washing levels. The washing chamber measures 680x670x1020mm (465L gross). Integrated compartment for the detergents. Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2672" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW6290" tab_id="GW6290"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW6290 (art. 860682)
LARGE CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (405 LITRES)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterical thermal disinfection
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen
- functioning protected by different levels password
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer
- possibility of installing up to 5 additional peristaltic pumps
- washing chamber and internal door made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- all internal piping made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- detergent cabinet made of AISI 304 stainless steel for 4 x 5 liters cans
- washing up to 3 levels
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 800 x 1940 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 680 x 670 x 890 mm
- n. 2 independent washing pumps
- high efficiency drain pump
- built-in boiler for fast cycles preheating water
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- double electronic door lock system for user safety
- emergency opening system
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 18 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without trolley
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW6290DS (art. 860683)
LARGE CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (405 LITRES)
- standard equipment
- n. 2 motors forced hot air drying system
Machine optionals
- IC6010 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- P36090B - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P46090B - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- PAD2 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X-60 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER - 60 HZ
- WD-FLUX - FLOW METER FOR ADDITIONALS PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- WD-LAN60 - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS3060 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTEINK - EXTERNAL IMPACT PRINTER
- WD-PRINTP6010 - CLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-PRINTS6010 - UNCLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-VDS - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
Technical Features
GW6290 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 20 |
Display | touch screen graphic display TFT color (4.3’’with capacitive sensing) |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 2 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. n° 5, 2 installed pumps |
Detergent level sensor | optional, max n° 5 |
Safety lock | yes |
Water heating | electrical – 18kW |
Steam connection | no |
Steam condenser | no |
Alarm display | yes, acoustic and visible |
Troubleshooting menu | yes |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish and Portuguese |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | no |
Traceability | storage of data for 100 most recently run programs |
RS232 serial port | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
LAN connection | optional |
Dirty/clean side printer | optional |
Interior lights | optional |
Water quality control(conductivity sensor) | optional |
Sprayers speed control | |
(heaven and background) | no |
Automatic recognition cart | no |
Pressure sensor circuit washing | optional |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes, n° 2 dryers - 220 m3 /h |
Drying heating element | yes |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Hot water inlet | yes, hardness max 10°f, max t 60°C |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm / 5 -8 ph, t max 60°C |
Cold water booster pump | yes |
Demineralized water booster pump | no |
External water softner | outside, optional |
Recirculation pump | n° 2 pumps of 600 l/min |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 900 x 800 x 1940mm - drop down door |
Inside (gross) | 670 x 650 x 835mm |
Net weight (Kg) | 280 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 18 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | Max 66 dB |

Possible Washing Configuration – GW6290 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2856" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]ONE INJECTION LEVEL This configuration has one washing level suitable for washing glassware of large dimensions Photo: C61 with injection insert L685 (76 spigots available) [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]TWO INJECTION LEVELS This configuration has two injection washing level suitable for washing glassware of small and medium dimensions. Photo: Level 1: C61 basic trolley with L680 direct injection system. Maximum useful height 260 mm, 76 spigots. Level 2: C63 telescopic support with L685 direct injection system. Maximum useful height 440 mm, 76 spigots. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2857" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner][vc_column_text]DIRECT INJECTION SYSTEMS | MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF GLASSWARE (mm) | ROTATING SPRAYER SYSTEM | MAXIMUM HEIGHT OF GLASSWARE(mm) | |||||||
3°LEVEL | C63_L690 Telescopic base injection system | 130 | 390 | 130 | 720 | C62 Telescopic base with rotating sprayer | 95 | 360 | 95 | 790 |
2°LEVEL | C63_L680 Telescopic base injection system | 180 | 510 | C62 Telescopic base with rotating sprayer | 170 | 640 | ||||
1°LEVEL | C61_L685 Telescopic base injection system | 220 | 220 | C61 Telescopic base with rotating sprayer at the bottom of the wash tank | 390 | 340 |
Accessories - GW6290 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="suggestion"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]L680 INJECTION WASHING SOLUTION UP TO 76 MEDIUM AND SMALL GLASSWARE



C61
1ST LEVEL BASIC CARRIER Stainless steel first level basic carrier with grid. It is suitable for positioning various glassware up 790mm in height. The C61 basic carrier is also used to position the injection systems (L685/L680/L690) on level 1. The injector inserts are inserted into the guide rails of the C61: in this case, the maximum height of glass items must be 720mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]C62
2ND AND 3RD LEVEL BASIC CARRIER Stainless steel second and third level basic carrier with rotating sprayer. It is used on its own and is suitable for positioning glassware up to 360mm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2859" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2860" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]C63
2ND AND 3RD LEVEL BASIC CARRIER Telescopic carrier for injection systems. The support is used to position the injection systems on levels 2 and 3. Suitable for positioning injection inserts (L680/685/690) directly in turn into the guide rails. Its flexibility allows the injection systems to be completely removed to simplify loading the glassware. Glass items max height 390mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]C64
DRUM BASIC CARRIER – 1ST LEVEL Stainless steel carrier to be positioned on the 1st level. With direct injection through specific nozzles. Suitable for washing drums with heights up to 530 mm and diameters up to 30 mm. Maximum useful height 835 mm.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2861" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2673" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]L680
UNIVERSAL GLASSWARE INSERT Injection stainless steel insert for washing a max of 76 small and medium glass items. Spigots at the same height of 140 mm. Preferential use of the insert on the 1st or 2nd level over the specific carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]L685
UNIVERSAL GLASSWARE INSERT Injection stainless steel insert for washing a max of 76 small and medium glass items. Spigots of differing heights make it possible to optimise loading of different sized glassware. This spigot configuration allows the system to be used on the 1st or 2nd level over the specific carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2863" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2864" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]L690
UNIVERSAL GLASSWARE INSERT Injection stainless steel insert for washing a max of 86 small glass items. Spigots at the same height of 110 mm. Preferential use of the insert on the 1ST, 2nd, 3rd level over the specific carriers.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LP6
PIPETTES WASHING INSERT Suitable for washing pipettes with max in height 450mm and 8.5mm as maximum diameter. It easily hooks into the hydraulic grip positioned on L680 and L685.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2676" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2674" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]C65-I
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR BIG DIMENSIONS GLASSWARES Injection stainless steel carrier for big dimensions glass items with drying system connection. Suitable for washing 9 bottles with max dimensions: diam. 175mm and in height 285 mm. Positioned on the lower level. C65S (not shown in the photo): same carrier for the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]C636-I
MIXED INJECTION CARRIER FOR BOTTLES Injection stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing max 36 narrow or wide-necked bottles of 250-1000 ml (max. diam. 90 mm, h 285mm).Positioned on the lower level. C636S (not shown in the photo): same carrier for the upper level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2867" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2868" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LM6-10U
DRUM INJECTION CARRIER Injection stainless steel carrier with drying system connection for washing 5 drum max. of different dimensions. The customer can customize the carrier thanks to the spigots of variable in height and the repositionable rails.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]L685CIL
INJECTION CARRIER FOR CYLINDERS Injection stainless steel carrier for washing 12 graduated cylinders max from 500ml to 2000ml. Positioned on the lower level. L690CIL (not shown in the photo): Suitable for washing a max of 36 graduated cylinders from 300ml to 700ml. Positioned on the lower level.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2675" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Professional line GW6010 drop down glass door glassware washers
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Large Capacity>GW6010[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW6010 is a glassware washer designed to work with one to five independent and flexible washing levels. Drop down door in glass. The washing chamber measures 550 x 620 x 685mm. Integrated compartment for the detergents. Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2774" img_size="full"][vc_column_text]Photo: GW6010M
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW6010 Double doors" tab_id="GW6010"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW6010 (art. 860512)
LARGE CAPACITY DOUBLE DOOR LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterial thermal disinfection
- capacity up to 5 adjustable levels
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen on both sides
- functioning protected by different levels password
- integrated built-in panel printer (optional)
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- ethernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- n. 2 drop down full glass door
- door locked for safety
- high pressure hot air drying system
- high efficiency Ecoslim steam condenser (optional)
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent and level sensor
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer and level sensor
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- detergent cabinet with removable tray for storing up to 3 x 5 liters cans + 1 x 1 liter can
- washing chamber made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external dimensions LxDxH: 650 x 720 x 1950 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 550 x 620 x 685 mm
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- floor drain connection
- drain pump (optional)
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 13 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without racks
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW6010T (art. 860595)
LARGE CAPACITY DOUBLE DOOR LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- standard equipment
- equipped with FAST cycles (max. 33 minutes)
Machine optionals
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- DRAINP6010 - DRAIN PUMP FOR WALL DRAIN
- IC6010 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- LED6010 - LED LIGHTING FOR WASHING CHAMBER
- P36010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P46010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD26010 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X6010 - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- RACKREC60 - WASHING TROLLEY RECOGNITION SYSTEM
- STEAMCO60 - ECOSLIM STEAM CONDENSER
- STEAMFEED60 - HYBRID STEAM HEATING
- WD-FLUX6010 - DETERGENT DOSAGE CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- WD-LAN60 - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS6010 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTEINK - EXTERNAL IMPACT PRINTER
- WD-PRINTP6010 - CLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-PRINTS6010 - UNCLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-VDS6010 - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW6010M (art. 860507)
LARGE CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterial thermal disinfection
- capacity up to 5 adjustable levels
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen
- functioning protected by different levels password
- integrated built-in panel printer (optional)
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- ehernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- drop down full glass door
- door locked for safety
- high pressure hot air drying system
- high efficiency Ecoslim steam condenser (optional)
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent and level sensor
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer and level sensor
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- detergent cabinet with removable tray for storing up to 3 x 5 liters cans + 1 x 1 liter can
- washing chamber made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external dimensions LxDxH: 650 x 720 x 1950 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 550 x 620 x 685 mm
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- floor drain connection
- drain pump (optional)
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 13 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without racks
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW6010TM (art. 860596)
LAREG CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- standard equipment
- equipped with FAST cycles (max. 33 minutes)
Technical Features
GW6010 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 20 |
Display | touch screen graphic display TFT color (4.3’’with capacitive sensing) |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 2 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. n° 4, 2 installed pumps |
Detergent level sensor | optional, max n° 4 |
Safety lock | yes |
Water heating | electrical – 12kW |
Steam connection | optional |
Steam condenser | optional |
Alarm display | yes, acoustic and visible |
Troubleshooting menu | yes |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish and Portuguese |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Traceability | storage of data for 100 most recently run programs |
RS232 serial port | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
LAN connection | optional |
Dirty/clean side printer | optional |
Interior lights | optional |
Water quality control(conductivity sensor) | optional |
Sprayers speed control | |
(heaven and background) | optional |
Automatic recognition cart | optional |
Pressure sensor circuit washing | optional |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes, 220 m3 /h |
Drying heating element | yes |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Hot water inlet | yes, hardness max 10°f, max t 60°C |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm / 5 -8 ph, t max 60°C |
Cold water booster pump | optional |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
External water softner | outside, optional |
Recirculation pump | 600 l/min |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 900 x 800 x 1940mm - drop down door |
Inside (gross) | 550x 620x 685mm |
Net weight (Kg) | 280 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 12 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | < 66 dB |

POSSIBLE WASHING CONFIGURATION GW6010 SERIES
[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
Some of the possibilities of washing on multiple levels with injection inserts | |||
Insert code | Nozzle height | Simultaneous positioning on multiple levels | Compatibility systems |
INS56U390 | 90 mm | 3 levels: 1°AB + 2°CD, 3°E-TOP | 1° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U4140 |
INS56U4140 | 140 mm | 3 levels: 1°AB + 2°BD+ 3°D-TOP | 2° 3° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U390 |
INS56U4180 | 180 mm | 2 levels: 1°AC +2°C-TOP | 2° level interchangeable with the inserts INS56U4140 or INS56U390 |
INS28U6260 | 260 mm | 2 levels: 1°A + 2°C | 2° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U4180 |
Accessories - GW6010 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestion"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]CLB510 CUSTOMIZABLE WASHING SOLUTION UP TO 5 LEVELS. MODULES TO BE CHOSEN BY THE CUSTOMER



CLB210
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of two inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CLB310
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of three inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2876" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2794" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CLB510
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of five inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LCB610
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER One level multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of two collectors (one any ½ surface). Suitable for different big dimensions glass items. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2800" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2882" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INSLP28U4140
MIXED INJECTION INSERT Injection insert specifically for glassware washing thanks to 28 nozzles measuring 140 mm and pipettes (max. 70), through a special manifold with 70 positions. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS12U4180DV
INJECTION INSERT WITH PARTITIONS Injection insert with 12 adjustable partitions and perimeter frame for better glassware positioning. Suitable for washing 12 bottles of max. 1L or 6L 2L flasks. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS12U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert without partitions and perimeter frame.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2879" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2880" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS20U4180DV
INJECTION INSERT WITH PARTITIONS Injection insert with 20 adjustable partitions and perimeter frame for better glassware positioning. Suitable for washing 20 bottles of max. 1L. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS20U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert without partitions and perimeter frame.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS56U4140
INJECTION INSERT Injection insert with 56 positions for small-medium dimensions glassware. Furnished with 56 spigots of 140mm in height with two dimensions plastic support for a better lodge of the items. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS56U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert with spigots of 180mm in height. INS56U390 (not shown in the photo): same insert with spigots of 90mm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2796" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2887" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INSPLAV10
WASHING INSERT Washing level for “CLB” series carriers. Spraying arm included. Suitable to lodge different inserts and glass items.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]COCI42
COLLECTOR FOR GRADUATED CYLINDERS OF LARGE DIMENSIONS Collector for washing 4 graduated cylinders from 500 ml up to 2000 ml. Suitable for positioning on half the trolley LCB610.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2802" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2885" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]COBE63
COLLECTOR FOR FLASKS Collector for washing 6 flasks of up to 2 litres (max. diameter: 140 mm) or three 6-litre flasks (max. diameter 188 mm). Fitted with 6 nozzles and plastic supports in two sizes for optimal glassware positioning. Suitable for positioning on half the trolley LCB610.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB50
INSERT FOR FLASKS AND BEAKERS Insert for flasks and beakers up to 250ml max. Suitable for positioning on half INSPLAV10.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2884" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Professional line GW7010 sliding down glass door glassware washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Large Capacity>GW7010[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW7010 is a glassware washer designed to work with one to five independent and flexible washing levels. External sliding door in glass. The washing chamber measures 550 x 620 x 685mm. Integrated compartment for the detergents. Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2773" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW7010 Double doors" tab_id="GW7010"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]GW7010 (art. 860599)
LAREG CAPACITY DOUBLE SLIDING DOOR LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterial thermal disinfection
- capacity up to 5 adjustable levels
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen on both sides
- functioning protected by different levels password
- integrated built-in panel printer (optional)
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- ethernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- n. 2 sliding down full glass door
- door locked for safety
- high pressure hot air drying system
- high efficiency Ecoslim steam condenser (optional)
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent and level sensor
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer and level sensor
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- detergent cabinet with removable tray for storing up to 3 x 5 liters cans + 1 x 1 liter can
- washing chamber made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external dimensions LxDxH: 780 x 800 x 1950 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 550 x 620 x 685 mm
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- floor drain connection
- drain pump (optional)
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 13 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without racks
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW7010T (art. 860646)
LARGE CAPACITY DOUBLE SLIDING DOOR LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- standard equipment
- equipped with FAST cycles (max. 33 minutes)
Machine optionals
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- DRAINP6010 - DRAIN PUMP FOR WALL DRAIN
- IC6010 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- LED6010 - LED LIGHTING FOR WASHING CHAMBER
- P36010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P46010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD26010 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X6010 - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- RACKREC60 - WASHING TROLLEY RECOGNITION SYSTEM
- STEAMCO60 - ECOSLIM STEAM CONDENSER
- STEAMFEED70 - HYBRID STEAM HEATING
- WD-FLUX6010 - DETERGENT DOSAGE CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- WD-LAN60 - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS6010 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTEINK - EXTERNAL IMPACT PRINTER
- WD-PRINTP6010 - CLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-PRINTS6010 - UNCLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-VDS6010 - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
GW7010M (art. 860598)
LARGE CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterial thermal disinfection
- capacity up to 5 adjustable levels
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen
- functioning protected by different levels password
- integrated built-in panel printer (optional)
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- ehernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- sliding down full glass door
- door locked for safety
- high pressure hot air drying system
- high efficiency Ecoslim steam condenser (optional)
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent and level sensor
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer and level sensor
- possibility of installing up to 2 additional peristaltic pumps
- detergent cabinet with removable tray for storing up to 3 x 5 liters cans + 1 x 1 liter can
- washing chamber made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external dimensions LxDxH: 780 x 800 x 1950 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 550 x 620 x 685 mm
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- floor drain connection
- drain pump (optional)
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 13 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without racks
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
GW7010TM (art. 860645)
LARGE CAPACITY LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (266 LT)
- standard equipment
- equipped with FAST cycles (max. 33 minutes)
Machine optionals
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- DRAINP6010 - DRAIN PUMP FOR WALL DRAIN
- IC6010 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- LED6010 - LED LIGHTING FOR WASHING CHAMBER
- P36010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P46010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- PAD26010 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X6010 - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- RACKREC60 - WASHING TROLLEY RECOGNITION SYSTEM
- STEAMCO60 - ECOSLIM STEAM CONDENSER
- STEAMFEED70 - HYBRID STEAM HEATING
- WD-FLUX6010 - DETERGENT DOSAGE CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- WD-LAN60 - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS6010 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTEINK - EXTERNAL IMPACT PRINTER
- WD-PRINTP6010 - CLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-PRINTS6010 - UNCLEAN SIDE PANEL PRINTER
- WD-VDS6010 - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
Technical Features
GW7010 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 20 |
Display | touch screen graphic display TFT color (4.3’’with capacitive sensing) |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 2 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. n° 4, 2 installed pumps |
Detergent level sensor | optional, max n° 4 |
Safety door block | yes |
Water heating | electrical – 12kW |
Steam connection | optional |
Steam condenser | optional |
Alarm display | yes, acoustic and visible |
Troubleshooting menu | yes |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish and Portuguese |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Traceability | storage of data for 100 most recently run programs |
RS232 serial port | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
LAN connection | optional |
Dirty/clean side printer | optional |
Interior lights | optional |
Water quality control(conductivity sensor) | optional |
Sprayers speed control | |
(heaven and background) | optional |
Automatic recognition cart | optional |
Pressure sensor circuit washing | optional |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes, 220 m3 /h |
Drying heating element | yes |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Hot water inlet | yes, hardness max 10°f, max t 60°C |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm / 5 -8 ph, t max 60°C |
Cold water booster pump | optional |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
External water softner | outside, optional |
Recirculation pump | 600 l/min |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 780x800x1950 mm - slide door |
Inside (gross) | 550 x 620 x 685 mm |
Net weight (Kg) | 300 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 12 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | Max 66 dB |

POSSIBLE WASHING CONFIGURATION GW7010 SERIES
[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
Some of the possibilities of washing on multiple levels with injection inserts | |||
Insert code | Nozzle height | Simultaneous positioning on multiple levels | Compatibility systems |
INS56U390 | 90 mm | 3 levels: 1°AB + 2°CD, 3°E-TOP | 1° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U4140 |
INS56U4140 | 140 mm | 3 levels: 1°AB + 2°BD+ 3°D-TOP | 2° 3° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U390 |
INS56U4180 | 180 mm | 2 levels: 1°AC +2°C-TOP | 2° level interchangeable with the inserts INS56U4140 or INS56U390 |
INS28U6260 | 260 mm | 2 levels: 1°A + 2°C | 2° level interchangeable with the insert INS56U4180 |
Accessories - GW7010 Series
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Suggestion" tab_id="Suggestion"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/2"][vc_column_text]CLB510 CUSTOMIZABLE WASHING SOLUTION UP TO 5 LEVELS. MODULES TO BE CHOSEN BY THE CUSTOMER



CLB210
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of two inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CLB310
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of three inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2876" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2794" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]CLB510
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER Multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of five inserts (not included) chosen by the customer.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]LCB610
MULTIFUNCTIONAL BASIC CARRIER One level multifunctional basic carrier to insert a maximum of two collectors (one any ½ surface). Suitable for different big dimensions glass items. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2800" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2882" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INSLP28U4140
MIXED INJECTION INSERT Injection insert specifically for glassware washing thanks to 28 nozzles measuring 140 mm and pipettes (max. 70), through a special manifold with 70 positions. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS12U4180DV
INJECTION INSERT WITH PARTITIONS Injection insert with 12 adjustable partitions and perimeter frame for better glassware positioning. Suitable for washing 12 bottles of max. 1L or 6L 2L flasks. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS12U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert without partitions and perimeter frame.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2879" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2880" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS20U4180DV
INJECTION INSERT WITH PARTITIONS Injection insert with 20 adjustable partitions and perimeter frame for better glassware positioning. Suitable for washing 20 bottles of max. 1L. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS20U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert without partitions and perimeter frame.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INS56U4140
INJECTION INSERT Injection insert with 56 positions for small-medium dimensions glassware. Furnished with 56 spigots of 140mm in height with two dimensions plastic support for a better lodge of the items. To be placed on the “CLB” series carriers. INS56U4180 (not shown in the photo): same insert with spigots of 180mm in height. INS56U390 (not shown in the photo): same insert with spigots of 90mm in height.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2796" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2887" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]INSPLAV10
WASHING INSERT Washing level for “CLB” series carriers. Spraying arm included. Suitable to lodge different inserts and glass items.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]COCI42
COLLECTOR FOR GRADUATED CYLINDERS OF LARGE DIMENSIONS Collector for washing 4 graduated cylinders from 500 ml up to 2000 ml. Suitable for positioning on half the trolley LCB610.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2802" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2885" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]COBE63
COLLECTOR FOR FLASKS Collector for washing 6 flasks of up to 2 litres (max. diameter: 140 mm) or three 6-litre flasks (max. diameter 188 mm). Fitted with 6 nozzles and plastic supports in two sizes for optimal glassware positioning. Suitable for positioning on half the trolley LCB610.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]SB50
INSERT FOR FLASKS AND BEAKERS Insert for flasks and beakers up to 250ml max. Suitable for positioning on half INSPLAV10.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2884" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
Smeg Professional Line GW7015 Extra Large Capacity Glassware Washer
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>Euiqpment>Glassware Washer>Smeg Large Capacity>GW7015[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_column_text]GW7015 is a glassware washer designed to work from one to various levels for washing glassware of high dimensions. The washing chamber measures 626x812x820mm (417 l gross). Integrated compartment for the detergents. Possibility for washing, thermic and chemical disinfection (up to 95°C) and forced-air drying system with filter.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="1/2"][vc_single_image image="2776" img_size="full"][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Specifications and Technical Features
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="GW7015 Double sliding down glass door" tab_id="GW7015"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]GW7015 (art. 860681)
HIGH CAPACITY DOUBLE SLIDING DOOR LABORATORY GLASSWARE WASHER (348 LT)
- washing up to 95°C - antibacterial thermal disinfection
- capacity up to 6 adjustable levels
- programs: 20 default + 20 custom
- multi-language TFT colour touch screen on both sides
- functioning protected by different levels password
- integrated built-in panel printer (optional)
- USB port for downloading washing cycles log
- ethernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- n. 2 sliding down full glass door
- door locked for safety
- high pressure hot air drying system
- high efficiency Ecoslim steam condenser (optional)
- peristaltic pump for liquid detergent and level sensor
- peristaltic pump for liquid neutralizer and level sensor
- possibility of installing up to 3 additional peristaltic pumps
- detergent cabinet with removable tray for storing up to 4 cans of 5 liters and one of 2 liters
- washing chamber made of AISI 316L stainless steel
- external panels made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- external dimensions LxDxH: 900 x 1000 x 1942 mm
- internal working dimensions LxDxH: 626 x 812 x 685 mm
- cold water, hot water and demineralized water connections
- floor drain connection
- drain pump (optional)
- electrical connection: 3/N/PE 400 V - 50 Hz - 22 kW max
- 60 Hz version available
- without racks
OTHER POSSIBLE CONFIGURATIONS
Machine optionals
- AF4050 - ABSOLUTE HEPA FILTER
- DRAINP7015 - DRAIN PUMP FOR WALL DRAIN
- IC6010 - QUALITY WASHING CHECK CONDUCTIVITY SENSOR
- LED6010 - LED LIGHTING FOR WASHING CHAMBER
- P36010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- P46010 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ANTIFOAM
- P57015 - PERISTALTIC PUMP FOR LIQUID ADDITIVES
- PAD26010 - BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- PAD2X6010 - ST. STEEL BOOSTER PUMP FOR NON-PRESSURE DEMINERALIZED WATER
- STEAMCO15 - ECOSLIM STEAM CONDENSER
- STEAMFEED15 - HYBRID STEAM HEATING FOR CHAMBER
- WD-FLUX6010 - DETERGENT DOSAGE CONTROL FOR ADDITIONAL PERISTALTIC PUMPS
- WD-LAN60 - DATA COMMUNICATION CARD
- WD-LS6010 - DETERGENT LEVEL SENSOR
- WD-PRINTEINK - EXTERNAL IMPACT PRINTER
- WD-VDS6010 - DUAL DRAIN VALVE
Technical Features
GW7015 TECHNICAL FEATURES | All versions |
Electronic control | microprocessor |
Standard programs stored | 20 |
Customisable programs | 20 |
Display | touch screen graphic display TFT color (4.3’’with capacitive sensing) |
Clock and calendar | yes |
Tank internal temperature | from room temperature to 95°C |
Accuracy | 0,1°C |
Temperature sensors in tank | n° 2 x PT 1000 CLASS B IEC 60751 |
Detergent and agents dosing system | max. n° 5, 2 installed pumps |
Detergent level sensor | optional, max n° 5 |
Safety door block | yes |
Water heating | electrical – 20kW |
Steam connection | optional |
Steam condenser | optional |
Alarm display | yes, acoustic and visible |
Troubleshooting menu | yes |
Program editing | yes, using customizable programs |
Display languages | Italian, English, French, German, Russian, Spanish and Portuguese |
AUXILIARY FUNCTIONS | |
External sensor duct | optional |
Traceability | storage of data for 100 most recently run programs |
RS232 serial port | yes |
Cycle file download | yes |
Cycle storage | yes |
LAN connection | optional |
Dirty/clean side printer | optional |
Interior lights | optional |
Water quality control(conductivity sensor) | optional |
Sprayers speed control | |
(heaven and background) | optional |
Automatic recognition cart | optional |
Pressure sensor circuit washing | optional |
DRYING SYSTEM | |
Drying fan | yes, 440 m3 /h |
Drying heating element | yes |
Prefilter class C 98% | yes |
HEPA filter class S 99,999% | optional |
WATER SUPPLY (PRESSURE 1,5-5 BAR) | |
Cold water inlet | yes, hardness max 42°f |
Hot water inlet | yes, hardness max 10°f, max t 60°C |
Demineralized water inlet | yes, < 30 μS/cm / 5 -8 ph, t max 60°C |
Cold water booster pump | optional |
Demineralized water booster pump | optional |
External water softner | outside, optional |
Recirculation pump | n°2 pumps of 600 l/min |
DIMENSIONS LxDxH mm | |
Outside (with built-in top) | 780x800x1950 mm - slide door |
Inside (gross) | 626x812x820mm |
Net weight (Kg) | 320 |
STAINLESS STEEL | |
Wash tank | AISI 316L |
Exterior covering | AISI 304 |
ELECTRICAL POWER SUPPLY | |
Max. voltage/power | 3/N/PE 400V - 50 Hz 20 kW |
NOISE LEVEL | max 66 dB |
Washing Configuration and Accessories - GW7015 Series
Please contact us for details information.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Specifications[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]
洗涤剂
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main>consumables>detergents[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Decon Laboratories Limited
With over 40 years experience in formulating and manufacturing surface active cleaning agents, Decon sets the standard for cleaning and decontamination around the world. Present their complete range of cleaning and disinfection agents, for laboratory, medical and industrial applications.[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/6"][vc_single_image image="2958" img_size="300x300" alignment="center"][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/6"][vc_column_text]




Details Information
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="decon 90" tab_id="decon90"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]decon 90
Properties : decon 90 is biodegradable bactericidal, non-flammable, and rinses away completely after use. decon 90 does NOT contain phosphates, enzymes, EDTA/NTA or chlorine bleaches. Formulation : An emulsion of highest quality anionic and non-ionic surface active agents, stabilising agents, alkalis, detergent builders and sequestering agents in an aqueous base. Supplied as a liquid concentrate, for dilution with water. Performance : decon 90 has successfully replaced the use of chromic acid mixtures in cleaning applications. Offering improved performance without the unacceptable hazards associated with the storage, handling, use and disposal of corrosive acids. decon 90 provides the ideal solution to the problems of achieving consistent and reliable cleaning/decontamination to the highest standard. Simple to use, economical and highly versatile, decon 90 is suitable for the most critical applications, combining remarkable cleaning and decontamination power with total rinsability and biodegradability. decon 90 sets the standard for cleaning around the world. It is used routinely in every major industry to achieve the optimum levels of cleaning/decontamination essential to modern sophisticated techniques. An essential aid to radioactive decontamination, decon 90 is widely used in establishments handling radioactive materials. Applications : Safe and effective for cleaning/decontaminating glassware, ceramics, plastics (not polycarbonate), rubbers, stainless steel and ferrous metals. (being alkaline, decon 90 is not suitable for use on non-ferrous metals, notably aluminium and zinc).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2958" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="decon neutracon" tab_id="neutracon"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]decon neutracon
decon neutracon is a neutral pH cleaning agent, for the safe and total cleaning and/or decontamination of materials which may be corroded, etched, degraded, discoloured or weakened by acidic or alkaline cleaning agents. Properties : Biodegradable, non-corrosive, non-flammable and totally rinsable. decon neutracon does NOT contain phosphates, enzymes, EDTA/NTA or chlorine bleaches. Formulation : A precise blend of highest quality anionic and non-ionic surface active agents in an aqueous polyhydric alcohol base, producing a neutral (pH7+/-) concentrate. Supplied as a viscous liquid for dilution with water. Performance : decon neutracon has been specifically formulated to provide an effective neutral cleaning agent with maximum cleaning/decontamination properties which is totally rinsable and biodegradable. The concentrate dilutes without precipitation and may be used in hard water areas without causing the deposition of calcium or magnesium, or the precipitation of iron. Working solutions remain active, do not lose strength after use and will not redeposit suspended soils. They are thermally stable and do not absorb carbon dioxide from the air. Oils and fats are solubilised without hydrolysis or degradation. Applications : decon neutracon is formulated for cleaning/decontaminating all non-ferrous metals, such as aluminium, zinc, copper, silver, brass etc., ‘soft’ glass, coated lenses, polymer surfaces and other sensitive materials which must not be cleaned by acids or alkalis. [/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2960" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="decon decomatic" tab_id="decomatic"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]decon decomatic
decon decomatic is a liquid cleaning agent for use in all makes of automatic glassware washing machine, that dispenses liquid detergent during the wash cycle, as a main alkali wash. May also be used as a pre-soak, prior to machine washing. Properties : Biodegradable, bactericidal non-foaming, non-flammable and totally rinsable. decon decomatic does NOT contain phosphates, enzymes, EDTA/NTA or chlorine bleaches. Formulation : A blend of highest quality amphoteric surface active agents, detergent builders, alkalis and sequestering agents in an aqueous base. Supplied as a liquid concentrate, for use in automatic glassware washing machines. Performance : decon decomatic has been specifically formulated to provide outstanding detergent and free-rinsing action for improved results from every type of automatic glassware washing machine designed to accept a main wash detergent in liquid form, with no adverse effect on the components of the machine itself. Effective against a broad range of contaminants, decon decomatic is very economical, providing exceptionally high performance cleaning, total rinsability and biodegradability. Applications : Safe and highly effective for cleaning/decontaminating glassware, ceramics, plastics (not polycarbonate), rubbers, stainless steel and ferrous metals. (being alkaline, decon decomatic is not suitable for use on non-ferrous metals, notably aluminium and zinc).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2957" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="decon acid rinse" tab_id="acidrinse"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]decon acid rinse
Acid rinse (neutraliser) and/or pre-wash (preliminary cleaner), for use in all types of automatic glassware washing machine, in conjunction with main wash detergents. Properties : Biodegradable, bactericidal non-foaming, non-flammable and totally rinsable. Formulation : A blend of highest quality aliphatic polycarboxylic acid, aliphatic alcohol and non-ionic surface active agent in an aqueous base. Supplied as a liquid concentrate, for use in automatic glassware washing machines. High grade ingredients selected for their non-foaming and free-rinsing characteristics, producing a product which is highly effective, totally rinsable, bactericidal and biodegradable. Performance : decon acid rinse improves the performance of automatic glassware washing machines by preventing the carry-over of traces of the main wash detergent, which may be alkaline or contain phosphates, and by inhibiting the deposition of lime salts from “hard” water supplies, on both the items being cleaned and the components of the automatic washing machine itself. Where contamination/soiling is acid soluble, a preliminary wash with decon acid rinse, using the pre-wash facility of the automatic washing machine, prior to the main alkali wash, is beneficial. Pre-wash is especially useful when cleaning apparatus contaminated with superficial greases, dried protein, iron hydroxide deposits etc. Applications : Safe and effective for cleaning/decontaminating glassware, ceramics, plastics, rubbers, stainless steel and ferrous metals. (being acidic, decon acid rinse is not suitable for use on non-ferrous metals, notably aluminium and zinc).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2956" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="dri-decon" tab_id="dri"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="2/3"][vc_column_text]dri-decon
dri-decon is a highly effective surface active cleaning agent, in granular form, for use in all types of automatic glassware washing machines that accept ‘powder’ detergents. For laboratory, medical and industrial applications. Properties : Biodegradable, non-flammable, non-foaming and totally rinsable. dri-decon does NOT contain enzymes, EDTA/NTA or chlorine bleaches. Formulation : A mixture of high grade surface active cleaning agents, alkalis, phosphate builders and sequestering agents in granular form. Supplied as a finely milled powder, for use in automatic glassware washing machines. A combination of powerful ingredients, selected for their non-foaming and free-rinsing characteristics combined with very high cleaning power to tackle the most tenacious contaminants. Performance : dri-decon is a highly effective cleaning / decontamination agent, specially formulated to give maximum performance with all types of automatic glassware washing machine, which use a main wash detergent in powder form. The potent cleaning action of dri-decon together with its solubility and free-rinsing characteristics ensures consistency and reliability of performance. dri-decon is safe and effective to use in all makes of automatic glassware washing machine, and has no adverse effect on the components of the machine itself. Used routinely, dri-decon is exceptionally economical and provides an ideal general purpose cleaning agent. Applications : Safe and effective for cleaning/decontaminating glassware, ceramics, plastics (not polycarbonate), rubbers, stainless steel and ferrous metals. (being alkaline, dri-decon is not suitable for use on non-ferrous metals, notably aluminium and zinc).[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_single_image image="2959" img_size="300x300"][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Back to Your Location[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Related Products
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row]{:}{:zh}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Decon Laboratories Limited
超过40年期间在配制和制造表面活性洗涤剂的经验,Decon设定了清洁和去污的环球标准. 全线洗涤剂和消毒产品介绍,适合实验室,医疗和工业应用.Decon 90
领先的洗涤剂和放射性除染剂.可被生物分解,杀菌性能,无磷酸盐,不易燃和可完全冲洗,没有残渣,decon 90 提供最高水平的一致性和可靠性的清洁和去污.neutracon
中性酸碱度洗涤剂,可用于敏感材料的安全清洁和去污,不会产生因使用酸性或碱性洗涤剂时可能发生的腐蚀,蚀刻,降解,变色或减弱现象.decomatic
不起泡沫”液体”洗涤剂用于所有类型洗瓶机.Dri-decon
不起泡沫”颗粒状”洗涤剂用于所有类型洗瓶机.decon acid rinse
酸冲洗剂(中和剂)和/或者预先洗涤(初步清洗剂),用于所有类型洗瓶机,与主要洗涤剂关联使用.详细产品信息
[/vc_column_text][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section title="Decon 90" tab_id="Decon90"][vc_column_text]Decon 90
特性:decon 90 是可被生物分解,杀菌效能,不易燃和使用后可完全冲洗. decon 90 不含磷酸盐、酵素、EDTA/NTA 或者氯漂白剂. 配制:选用最优质的负离子和非离子表面活化剂,稳定剂,碱,洗涤助剂和隔离剂在水溶液中进行乳化.作为浓缩液体供应,用水稀释使用. 表现:decon 90 成功地替换了应用铬酸混合物清洁的应用.没有了不能接受的危险,如存贮,管理,使用和处置使用后的腐蚀酸性液体的问题. decon 90 为最高标准的一致性或可靠清洁/去污的问题提供了 理想的解答. 使用简单,经济和多用性,decon 90 适用于最关键的应用,结合卓越的清洁和去污能力与完全可清洗性和生物可分解性. decon 90 设定了清洗的环球标准. 在每家大型企业为达到现代化精密技术必要的和最理想的清洁或去污条件的已经定期地使decon 90. 对放射性去污不可缺的助手, decon 90 被广泛用于处理放射性材料的企业. 应用:安全和有效,可用于清洁或净化玻璃器皿、陶瓷、塑料(不包括聚碳酸酯材料)、橡胶、不锈钢和亚铁金属.(由于是碱性, decon 90 不适用在非铁金属,特别是铝和锌).[/vc_column_text][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="neutracon" tab_id="neutracon"][vc_column_text]neutracon
中性酸碱度洗涤剂,可安全地使用,不会产生因使用酸性或碱性洗涤剂时.可能发生的腐蚀,蚀刻,降解,变色或减弱现象. 特性:可被生物分解的,无腐蚀性,不易燃和完全可冲洗. decon neutracon 不包含磷酸盐、酵素、EDTA/NTA 或者氯漂白剂 配制: 选用最优质的负离子和非离子表面活化剂精确混合在一个含水多羟的酒精基础液,产生中性(pH7+/-)浓缩液. 作为黏性液体供应,用水稀释使用. 表现:decon neutracon 特别为提供有效的中性洗涤提供最大清洁或去污物特性而配制,也可以生物分解和完全冲洗. 浓缩液稀释后,不会有沈淀,并且也可以用于硬水区域不会导致钙或镁的和铁的沈淀.使用后工作溶液能保持活跃,不丢失力量并且不将已经悬浮的固体再次沈淀.他们对热量稳定,并且不吸收空气中的二氧化碳. 油和油脂溶解不会水解或分解. 应用: decon neutracon 为清洁或净化所有有色金属,例如不能被酸或碱清洗的铝、锌、铜、银、黄铜等,‘软’玻璃、涂层透镜、聚合物表面和其它敏感材料.[/vc_column_text][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="decomatic" tab_id="decomatic"][vc_column_text]decomatic
液体洗涤剂用于所有自动洗瓶机,在清洗过程中加入洗涤剂作为主要碱清洗过程. 在机器洗涤之前也可作为前浸泡. 特性: 可被生物分解的,杀菌,不起泡,不易燃和可完全冲洗. decon decomatic 不包含磷酸盐、酵素、EDTA/NTA或者氯漂白剂 配制: 最优质的两性表面活化剂,洗涤剂助剂,碱和隔离剂在水基礎溶液中混合. 作为浓缩液体供应,适用在全自动洗瓶机. 表现:decon decomatic 特别为每种类型的自动洗瓶机提供出众的洗涤和完全冲洗效果而配制,可用于使用液体清洗剂为最要洗涤过程的洗瓶机,不会对机器组件构成影响. 有效用于各种各样的污染物, decon decomatic 是非常经济的,提供格外的高性能清洁、可完全冲洗性和生物可分解性. 应用:安全和有效,可用于清洁或净化玻璃器皿、陶瓷、塑料(不包括聚碳酸酯材料)、橡胶、不锈钢和亚铁金属.(由于是碱性, decomatic decon不适用在非铁金属,特别是铝和锌).[/vc_column_text][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="dri-decon" tab_id="dri-decon"][vc_column_text]dri-decon
高效的表面活性洗涤剂,颗粒状形式,用于所有类型使用”颗粒状”洗涤剂的自动洗瓶机.可应用在实验室,医疗和工业应用. 特性: 可被生物分解的,不起泡,不易燃和可完全冲洗. dri-decon 不含酵素, EDTA/NTA 或氯漂白剂. 配制: 混合高级表面活性的洗涤剂,碱,磷酸盐促进剂和隔离剂物制成颗粒状. 以碾碎的微细粉末状太供应,用于自动洗瓶机. 强而有力的成份组合,不起泡和可完全冲洗的特征结合了以非常高的清洁效能.足而应付最顽强的污染物. 表现:dri-decon 是一个高效的清洁/去污剂,特别为主清洗过程使用粉末清洗剂的自动洗瓶机配制,能使清洗达到最高性能. dri-decon 高效能的清洗作用与它的可溶性和可完全冲洗性保证了一贯性和可靠性。 dri-decon 是可以安全地和有效地使用在不同的自动洗瓶机,并且对机器组件不会构成影响 定期使用dri-decon 是格外经济的,并且是一般洗涤时理想的洗涤剂. 应用:安全和有效,可用于清洁或净化玻璃器皿、陶瓷、塑料(不包括聚碳酸酯材料)、橡胶、不锈钢和亚铁金属.(由于是碱性, dri-decon 不适用在非铁金属,特别是铝和锌).[/vc_column_text][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section title="acid rinse" tab_id="acidrinse"][vc_column_text]acid rinse
酸冲洗(中和剂)和/或者预先洗涤(初步清洗剂),用于所有类型自动洗瓶机,与主要洗涤剂同时使用. 特性: 可被生物分解的,杀菌,不起泡,不易燃和可完全冲洗 配制: 选用最优质的羧酸酸、醇和非离子表面活化剂在水性基础中混合. 作为浓缩液体供应,适用在全自动洗瓶机 选用高质量不起泡和可完全冲洗特征原料,产生出高效,可完全冲洗,杀菌性能和可被生物分解的洗涤剂. 表现:decon acid rinse 改进自动洗瓶机的表现,防止主洗涤剂的成份(如碱性或包含磷酸盐和防止因使用“硬”水产生的石灰沈淀)转移到被清洗的器皿和自动洗瓶机的组件. 当污秽或脏物是酸可溶性,在洗瓶机碱性主清洗前,可使用decon acid rinse 作为预洗,可改善清洗效果.如果清洗器皿表面沾染了油膏,干蛋白质,铁氢氧类沈淀,预先洗涤特别有用. 应用:安全和有效,可用于清洁或净化玻璃器皿、陶瓷、塑料(不包括聚碳酸酯材料)、橡胶、不锈钢和亚铁金属.(由于是碱性, decon acid rinse 不适用在非铁金属,特别是铝和锌).[/vc_column_text][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row]{:}
Laboratory Freezer with electronic control
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Laboratory Freezer with electronic control
Alarm test function This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test. Forced air cooling Highly efficient fans cool freshly stored produce quickly and maintain an even refrigeration temperature throughout the interior. Efficient refrigeration system Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced. Temperature alarm The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored. Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3 All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-square" add_icon="true" title="LGv 5010 (478 Litres)" tab_id="lgv5010"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text]

LGv 5010 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab freezer with comfort electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 3.410 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 1,245 kWh/a |
Noise level | 55 dB |
Net capacity, total | 337 l |
Freezer compartment | 337 l |
Refrigerant | R 290 |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | dynamic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | automatic |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 3.0 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 184.4 / 75.1 / 75.0 cm |
Insulation | 70 - 70 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 124.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 114.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Adjustable temperature range | -9 °C to -35 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | when mains power returns |
Maximum fluctuation | 4.9°C |
Gradient | 5.8 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Plastic white |
Type of castors | Castors with arrestor at the front, fixed castors at the rear |
Water drain | ✔ |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 8 |
Baskets in freezer compartment | 2 |
Shelf material | Plastic-coated grids |
Load capacity storage shelf, refrigerator compartment | 60 kg |
Door design | HardLine |
Handle | Ergonomic slimline handle with opening mechanism |

Spark-free Freezer with electronic control
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Laboratory Freezer with electronic control and spark-free interior
Explosion protection: ATEX 95
The Atex 95 certification confirms that Liebherr laboratory fridges and freezers with explosion protection are appropriate for the storage of explosive and highly flammable materials within the meaning of EU Directive 2014/34/EU (ATEX).
Alarm test function
This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test.
Efficient refrigeration system
Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced.
Temperature alarm
The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored.
Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3
All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-square" add_icon="true" title="LGex 3410 (310 Litres)" tab_id="lgex3410"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
LGex 3410 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab freezer with Comfort electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 1.309 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 478 kWh/a |
Noise level | 45 dB |
Net capacity, total | 284 l |
Freezer compartment | 284 l |
Refrigerant | R 600a |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | static |
Defrosting freezer compartment | manual |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 1.5 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 184 / 60.1 / 61.8 cm |
Insulation | 77 - 65 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 91.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 86.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Temperature range refrigerator compartment | -9 °C to -30 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | when mains power returns |
Maximum fluctuation | 4.2 °C |
Gradient | 6.9 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Plastic white |
Type of castors | — |
Water drain | — |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 8 |
Storage shelves freezer compartment | 8 |
Shelf material | Evaporator plates |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 24 kg |
Door design | HardLine |
Handle | Ergonomic slimline handle with opening mechanism |
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-square" add_icon="true" title="LGUex 1500 (139 Litres)" tab_id="lguex1500"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
LGUex 1500 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab freezer with Comfort electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 0.803 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 294 kWh/a |
Noise level | 45 dB |
Net capacity, total | 129 l |
Freezer compartment | 129 l |
Refrigerant | R 600a |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | static |
Defrosting freezer compartment | manual |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 1.0 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 82 / 60.1 / 61.8 cm |
Insulation | 55 - 55 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 45.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 42.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Temperature range refrigerator compartment | -9 °C to -26 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | when mains power returns |
Maximum fluctuation | 3.3 °C |
Gradient | 6.6 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Plastic white |
Type of castors | — |
Water drain | — |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 3 |
Baskets in freezer compartment | 1 |
Shelf material | Evaporator plates |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 24 kg |
Door design | HardLine |
Handle | Ergonomic slimline handle with opening mechanism |
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row]

Heavy-duty Freezer (597 Litres)
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Heavy-duty Freezer for Research and Laboratory
Alarm test function This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test. Forced air cooling Highly efficient fans cool freshly stored produce quickly and maintain an even refrigeration temperature throughout the interior. Efficient refrigeration system Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced. Upward-hinged, detachable unit compartment cover The refrigeration components are safely integrated into the upper section where they can be easily accessed. For cleaning or servicing purposes, the compressor compartment cover can be easily opened on an upward hinge to guarantee excellent accessibility, so it possible to easily clean the filter on the condenser, which is positioned behind the unit compartment cover, without having to move the appliance. Temperature alarm The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored. Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3 All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-stop" add_icon="true" title="LGPv 6520 (597 Litres) " tab_id="lgpv6520"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
LGPv 6520 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab Freezer with profi electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 3.743 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 1,367 kWh/a |
Noise level | 60 dB |
Net capacity, total | 430 l |
Freezer compartment | 430 l |
Refrigerant | R 290 |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | dynamic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | automatic |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 4.0 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 216.0 / 70.0 / 83.0 cm |
Insulation | 83 - 60 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 158.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 133.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Adjustable temperature range | -9 °C to -35 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | immediately upon power failure for 72h |
Maximum fluctuation | 3.6 °C |
Gradient | 2.9 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Chrome-nickel-steel |
Type of castors | Castors with arrestor at the front, fixed castors at the rear |
Water drain | ✔ |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 0 |
Storage shelves freezer compartment | 4 |
Shelf material | Plastic-coated grids |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 60 kg |
of which height-adjustable | 4 |
Door design | SwingLine design |
Handle | Handle moulding |

Heavy-duty Freezer (596 Litres, 2 doors)
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Heavy-duty Freezer for Research and Laboratory
Alarm test function This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test. Forced air cooling Highly efficient fans cool freshly stored produce quickly and maintain an even refrigeration temperature throughout the interior. Efficient refrigeration system Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced. Upward-hinged, detachable unit compartment cover The refrigeration components are safely integrated into the upper section where they can be easily accessed. For cleaning or servicing purposes, the compressor compartment cover can be easily opened on an upward hinge to guarantee excellent accessibility, so it possible to easily clean the filter on the condenser, which is positioned behind the unit compartment cover, without having to move the appliance. Temperature alarm The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored. Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3 All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-pause" add_icon="true" title="LGPv 6527 (596 Litres) (1 compartment with 2 doors)" tab_id="lgpv6527"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text]

LGPv 6527 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab Freezer with profi electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 5.529 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 2,019 kWh/a |
Noise level | 60 dB |
Net capacity, total | 429 l |
Freezer compartment | 429 l |
Refrigerant | R 290 |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | dynamic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | automatic |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 4.0 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 216.0 / 70.0 / 83.0 cm |
Insulation | 83 - 60 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 162.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 136.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Adjustable temperature range | -9 °C to -35 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | immediately upon power failure for 72h |
Maximum fluctuation | 3.6 °C |
Gradient | 2.9 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Chrome-nickel-steel |
Type of castors | Castors with arrestor at the front, fixed castors at the rear |
Water drain | ✔ |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 0 |
Storage shelves freezer compartment | 4 |
Shelf material | Plastic-coated grids |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 60 kg |
of which height-adjustable | 4 |
Door design | SwingLine design |
Handle | Handle moulding |

Heavy-duty Freezer (856 Litres)
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Heavy-duty Freezer for Research and Laboratory
Alarm test function This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test. Forced air cooling Highly efficient fans cool freshly stored produce quickly and maintain an even refrigeration temperature throughout the interior. Efficient refrigeration system Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced. Upward-hinged, detachable unit compartment cover The refrigeration components are safely integrated into the upper section where they can be easily accessed. For cleaning or servicing purposes, the compressor compartment cover can be easily opened on an upward hinge to guarantee excellent accessibility, so it possible to easily clean the filter on the condenser, which is positioned behind the unit compartment cover, without having to move the appliance. Temperature alarm The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored. Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3 All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-square" add_icon="true" title="LGPv 8420 (856 Litres)" tab_id="lgpv8420"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
LGPv 8420 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab Freezer with profi electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 4.762 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 1,739 kWh/a |
Noise level | 60 dB |
Net capacity, total | 629 l |
Freezer compartment | 629 l |
Refrigerant | R 290 |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | dynamic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | automatic |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 4.0 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 216.0 / 79.0 / 98.0 cm |
Insulation | 83 - 60 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 183.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 151.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Adjustable temperature range | -9 °C to -35 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | immediately upon power failure for 72h |
Maximum fluctuation | 5.7 °C |
Gradient | 4.5 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Chrome-nickel-steel |
Type of castors | Castors with arrestor at the front, fixed castors at the rear |
Water drain | ✔ |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 0 |
Storage shelves freezer compartment | 4 |
Shelf material | Plastic-coated grids |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 60 kg |
of which height-adjustable | 4 |
Door design | SwingLine design |
Handle | Handle moulding |

Heavy-duty freezer (1361 Litres)
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Heavy-duty Freezer for Research and Laboratory
Alarm test function
This test function can be used to check whether an internally or externally connected alarm system is functioning correctly. The appliance’s refrigeration performance is not affected by this test.
Forced air cooling
Highly efficient fans cool freshly stored produce quickly and maintain an even refrigeration temperature throughout the interior.
Efficient refrigeration system
Liebherr guarantees the outstanding quality of its refrigeration systems through expertise derived from decades of experience in the refrigeration technology sector, and through continuous research and development. By employing only premium-quality compressors, condensers, evaporators and other refrigeration components the energy consumption and operating costs of Liebherr appliances are significantly reduced.
Upward-hinged, detachable unit compartment cover
The refrigeration components are safely integrated into the upper section where they can be easily accessed. For cleaning or servicing purposes, the compressor compartment cover can be easily opened on an upward hinge to guarantee excellent accessibility, so it possible to easily clean the filter on the condenser, which is positioned behind the unit compartment cover, without having to move the appliance.
Temperature alarm
The integrated temperature alarm indicates if the lower or upper alarm thresholds have been breached. It uses both acoustic and visual signals to provide maximum security for goods that have been stored.
Temperature stability and consistency EN 60068-3
All laboratory refrigerators and freezers are tested at the state-of-the-art Liebherr development facilities according to procedure EN 60068-3 for measuring temperature stability. This involves measuring the temperature at nine different points in the appliance interiors.[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_tta_tabs][vc_tta_section i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-pause" add_icon="true" title="LGPv 1420 (1361 Litres)" tab_id="lgpv1420"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/4"][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][vc_column_inner width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
LGPv 1420 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab Freezer with profi electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 7.271 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 2,654 kWh/a |
Noise level | 60 dB |
Net capacity, total | 980 l |
Freezer compartment | 980 l |
Refrigerant | R 290 |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | dynamic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | automatic |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 4.5 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 216.0 / 143.0 / 83.0 cm |
Insulation | 83 - 60 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 253.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 207.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Adjustable temperature range | -9 °C to -26 °C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | immediately upon power failure for 72h |
Maximum fluctuation | 6.7 °C |
Gradient | 4.3 °C |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Left or right |
Material of interior containers | Chrome-nickel-steel |
Type of castors | Castors with arrestor at the front, castors at the rear |
Water drain | ✔ |
Drawers in freezer compartment | 0 |
Storage shelves freezer compartment | 8 |
Shelf material | Plastic-coated grids |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 60 kg |
of which height-adjustable | 8 |
Door design | SwingLine design |
Handle | Handle moulding |
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_tta_section][/vc_tta_tabs][/vc_column][/vc_row]

Spark-free Fridge-Freezer combination
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
Laboratory fridge-freezer with electronic control and spark-free interior


LCexv 4010 MediLine
General product information |
|
Product group output channels | Lab combination with Comfort electronic controller |
Output and consumption | |
Energy consumption in 24h | 1.800 kWh / 24h |
Energy consumption per year | 657 kWh/a |
Noise level | 52 dB |
Net capacity, total | 345 l |
Refrigerator compartment | 240 l |
Freezer compartment | 105 l |
Refrigerant | R 600a |
Cooling system, refrigerator compartment | dynamic |
Cooling system, freezer compartment | static |
Defrosting cooling compartment | automatic |
Defrosting freezer compartment | manual |
Voltage | 220-240 V ~ |
Frequency | 50 Hz |
Connection rating | 1.5 A |
Dimensions and weight | |
Product dimensions (H/W/D) | 200.3 / 60.1 / 61.8 cm |
Insulation | 70 - 70 mm |
Weight (with packaging) | 92.00 kg |
Weight (without packaging) | 87.00 kg |
Control and functions | |
Control | Electronic control system |
Control unit | Tasten |
Temperature range refrigerator compartment | +3 °C to +16 °C |
Temperature setting range freezing | -9°C to -30°C |
Temperature display | external digital |
Malfunction: Warning signal | optical and acoustical |
potential-free contact | ✔ |
Power failure alarm | when mains power returns |
SmartMonitoring | retrofittable, connectivity application available as option |
Freezer compartment | |
No. of drawers in freezer compartment | 3 |
Design and features | |
Side wall material | steel |
Colour | white |
Door/Cover material | Steel |
Lock | fitted |
Self-closing door | ✔ |
Door hinges | Right replaceable |
Material of interior containers | Plastic white |
Type of castors | — |
Storage shelves in freezer compartment | 0 |
Material adjustable shelves freezer compartment | Glass |
Load capacity adjustable shelves freezer compartment | 24 kg |
Storage shelves, refrigerator compartment | 5 |
of which height-adjustable | 4 |
Storage shelf material, refrigerator compartment | Glass |
Load capacity storage shelf, refrigerator compartment | 40 kg |
Illumination cooling compartment | — |
Door design | HardLine |
Handle | Ergonomic slimline handle with opening mechanism |

UF V 系列 | 超低温冰箱 带真空隔热和电机门锁
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Freezer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4012,4010,4009,4011" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" wrap="yes" title="UFV SERIES"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
The BINDER ultra low temperature freezer ensures the safe storage of samples at -80 °C. It combines outstanding environmental friendliness with low energy consumption, convenient operation and an individual safety concept.
Important characteristics
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
UF V 500 | 477 | 826 x 1966 x 938 | 606 x 1300 x 605 |
UF V 700 | 700 | 1110 x 1966 x 938 | 890 x 1300 x 605 |
Designation | UFV500-230V |
Option model | Standard |
Order number | 9020-0347 |
Measures | |
Interior volume [L] | 477 |
Net weight of the unit (empty) [kg] | 247 |
permitted load [kg] | 200 |
Permitted load of individual compartment [kg] | 50 |
Doors | |
Unit doors | 1 |
Internal Dimensions | |
Width [mm] | 606 |
Height [mm] | 1300 |
Depth [mm] | 605 |
Outer dimensions | |
Width net [mm] | 826 |
Height net [mm] | 1966 |
Depth net [mm] | 938 |
Wall clearance sidewise [mm] | 250 |
Wall clearance back [mm] | 100 |
Environment-specific data | |
Energy consumption at set-point -80 °C and ambient temperature = 21 °C [kWh/d] | 7.9 |
Sound-pressure level [dB(A)] | 47 |
Fixtures | |
Number of shelves (std./max.) | Mar-13 |
Load-variants | |
Freezer racks per compartment | 4 |
Cryoboxes, 50 mm | 352 |
Performance Data Temperature | |
Temperature range [°C] | -86…-40 |
Temperature variation at -80 °C [± K] | 2.5 |
Cooling down time from 22 °C to -80 °C [min] | 360 |
Warm-up time during power failure from -80 °C / -122 °F to -60 °C / -76 °F [min] | 230 |
Electrical data | |
Rated Voltage [V] | 230 |
Power frequency [Hz] | 50 |
Nominal power [kW] | 1.6 |
Unit fuse [A] | 10 |
Phase (Nominal voltage) | 1~ |
Designation | UFV700-230V¹ |
Option model | Standard |
Order number | 9020-0348 |
Measures | |
Interior volume [L] | 700 |
Net weight of the unit (empty) [kg] | 288 |
permitted load [kg] | 200 |
Permitted load of individual compartment [kg] | 50 |
Doors | |
Unit doors | 1 |
Internal Dimensions | |
Width [mm] | 890 |
Height [mm] | 1300 |
Depth [mm] | 605 |
Outer dimensions | |
Width net [mm] | 1110 |
Height net [mm] | 1966 |
Depth net [mm] | 938 |
Wall clearance sidewise [mm] | 250 |
Wall clearance back [mm] | 100 |
Environment-specific data | |
Energy consumption at set-point -80 °C and ambient temperature = 21 °C [kWh/d] | 8.1 |
Average heat dissipation at set-point -80 °C and ambient temperature = 21 °C [W] | 340 |
Sound-pressure level [dB(A)] | 47 |
Fixtures | |
Number of shelves (std./max.) | Mar-13 |
Load-variants | |
Freezer racks per compartment | 6 |
Cryoboxes, 50 mm | 528 |
Performance Data Temperature | |
Temperature range [°C] | -86…-40 |
Temperature variation at -80 °C [± K] | 2.5 |
Temperature fluctuation at -80 °C [± K] | 1.5 |
Cooling down time from 22 °C to -80 °C [min] | 450 |
Warm-up time during power failure from -80 °C / -122 °F to -60 °C / -76 °F [min] | 250 |
Electrical data | |
Rated Voltage [V] | 230 |
Power frequency [Hz] | 50 |
Nominal power [kW] | 1.6 |
Unit fuse [A] | 10 |
Phase (Nominal voltage) | 1~ |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
UF V 500 | 483 | 830x1985x885 | 619x1300x600 |
UF V 700 | 711 | 1120x1985x885 | 911x1300x600 |

Professional Freezer -40 °C
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Freezer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="1217" img_size="full"][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" shape="square" size="sm" align="center" i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-download" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.smeg-instruments.com%2Fajax%2Fload_product_pdf_instruments%2F15990%2F|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Model: C40S60C1A
- temperature range from -42 °C to -10 °C
- internal volume 600 liters
- n. 1 blind self-closing door
- hinges for door opening on right side (possibility to indicate left side when ordering)
- n. 1 safety door lock with key
- microprocessor electronic control
- soft touch user interface with LCD display
- n. 4 languages available (Italian, English, French, Spanish)
- memory capacity of 4 MB - 46000 data record, last 20 alarms available on display
- audible and visual alarms
- n. 7 different alarms: high temperature (adjustable threshold), low temperature (adjustable threshold), open door, condenser cleaning, probes defective, power failure, backup battery failure
- 12 V backup battery (optional) for temperature visualization and alarms acquisition up to 48h without power connection
- USB port for data downloading
- GSM module (optional)
- Ethernet port for LAN connection (optional)
- evaporator static type
- manual defrosting
- default configuration: n. 6 drawers made of AISI 304 stainless steel with Plexiglas frontal side
- alternative configuration: shelves made of AISI 304 stainless steel and height adjustable (optional, up to 6)
- n. 4 wheels + n. 2 front mounting adjustable feet
- internal structure made of AISI 304 stainless steel
- ecological polyurethane insulation 100 mm thick
- external dimensions LxDxH: 780 x 840 x 1930 mm
- weight 173 kg
- electrical connection: 1/N/PE 230 V - 50 Hz - 580 W
- detachable power cord with Schuko plug

2-IN-1 MAGFUGE CENTRIFUGE AND MAGNETIC STIRRER
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][vc_btn title="Download brochure" style="flat" color="inverse" size="xs" align="center" i_type="openiconic" i_icon_openiconic="vc-oi vc-oi-doc-inv" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:https%3A%2F%2Fwww.heathrowscientific.com%2Fimg%2Fproduct%2Fdescription%2FHS-2018_MagFuge_Sell-Sheet_LO-RES.pdf|||"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
MAGFUGE®
The Industry’s first High-speed Centrifuge and Magnetic Stirrer in ONE unit.
Product Highlights
- Save money by only having to purchase one unit that has the functionality of both a high performance centrifuge and magnetic stirrer
- Easy to use with a digital display, one button programming and tool free rotor exchange
- Stay focused in the lab with ultra-quiet operation
- Reduce down-time with a reliable unit you can trust with 3-year warranty
-
- Made from a durable chemically resistant ABS and polycarbonate making it easy to clean, maintenance free and helps lower the cost of ownership
- The modern low-profile design is compact and has a small footprint for labs with limited bench space and limited height that ultimately helps reduced clutter in the lab
- An easy to use back-lit digital control panel for time, speed and operations ensures effective outcomes and streamlines the work flow process by allowing for quick set up
- US Design Patent No. D814,045 and Utility Patent Pending
- Community Design No. 003515337-0001-0002 European Patent App. 3 246 088
- Ideal for most protocols requiring fast spins (12,500rpm / 9,800 x g), and appropriate for PCR, microfilter cell separation, and HPLC protocols
- Adjustable time (30 seconds to 60 minutes) and speed (500 to 12,500 RPM)
- Variable speed can be set in RPM or RCF and has rapid acceleration and fast controlled breaking
- Two rotors included, 12 place for 1.5/2.0 mL tubes and 6 place for 5 mL tubes with adapters for additional tube sizes
- Manual lid override allows users to open lid in case of a power failure and prevents loss of samples
- Safety features help ensure it will not operate when the lid is open, a rotor is jammed, or the unit is out of balance
- Ideal for work with sensitive samples such as cell lines and protocols requiring more aggressive mixing to quickly achieve full dilution of samples in solution
- Multiple stirring modes, clockwise, c. clockwise and oscillate enable protocols to be controlled precisely for reproducible results
- Adjustable time (30 seconds to 60 minutes or continuous) and speed (50 to 2,500 RPM)
- After hours of continuous use, the unit remains cool ensuring sample integrity
- Sensor technology prevents the stirrer rotor from being used above 2,500 RPM helping to protect users and prevent unit damage
- Two silicone mats are included to help prevent spills and to help keep vessels stable
- High-quality rare-earth magnets are used in the stirrer rotor to ensure the strongest magnetic coupling
- Two rare-earth stir bars (40 x 12 mm) included have PTFE coating for chemical resistance
- MagFuge®
- Three Rotors: 5 mL Tube Rotor, 1.5/2.0 mL Tube Rotor, Stirrer Rotor
- 12 Tube adapters 0.2 mL
- 12 Tube adapters for 0.5 mL
- 2 Silcone mats for stirrer lid
- 2 Rare-Earth PTFE coated stir bars stir bars
- 1 Low voltage, double insulated power adapter with 4 cord sets
Model | Color | L x W x H |
120581 | Gray/Purple | 9.2 x 7.3 x 4.7 in (23.5 x 18.5 x12 cm) |
120582 | Gray/Blue | 9.2 x 7.3 x 4.7 in (23.5 x 18.5 x12 cm) |

Cimarec+ Stirring Hotplates Series
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Hotplate & Stirrer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4208,4209,4210,4211" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Our new Thermo Scientific™ Cimarec+™ series digital stirring hotplates offer precise stirring control, exceptional safety and temperature performance for your routine protocols. The Cimarec+ Series are available in three sizes, providing flexibility from microscale chemistries to production operations.
Advanced technology
- Stir-Trac features innovative engineering for slow-speed stirring, consistent speed control, and strong magnetic coupling
- Temperature adjustable in 1 degree increments
- Hot Top warning system protects from accidental burns with prominent display when heating surface is above 50°C (122°F)
- Top plate choices in ceramic or aluminum
- Easy-to-read LED display for heating and stirring, besides 4"x 4" Hotplate Stirrer, which has digital temperature and analog stirring control.
- Raised display design protects electronics from spills
- Optional temperature probe and splash guard protection shield
- Variable sizes for different sample volumes
Model No. | SP88854105 | SP88857105 | SP88850105 |
Speed | 50 to 1,500rpm | 50 to 1,500rpm | 50 to 1,500rpm |
Temperature Range (Metric) | 540°C (Max Temperature) | 540°C (Max Temperature) | 400°C (Max Temperature) |
Surface Area (English) Heating | 4.25 x 4.25 in. | 7.25 x 7.25 in. | 10.25 x 10.25 in. |
Surface Area (Metric) Heating | 10.8 x 10.8cm | 18.4 x 18.4cm | 26.0 x 26.0cm |
Top Plate Material | Ceramic | Ceramic | Ceramic |
Voltage | 230V | 230V | 230V |
Hertz | 50/60Hz | 50/60Hz | 50/60Hz |
Certifications/Compliance | cCSAus, CE | cCSAus, CE | cCSAus, CE |
Shipping Weight (English) | 8.4 lb. | 11.2 lb. | 16.5 lb. |
Shipping Weight (Metric) | 3.8kg | 5.1kg | 7.5kg |
Stirring Range | 50 to 1,500rpm | 50 to 1,500rpm | 50 to 1,500rpm |
Dimensions (L x W x H) | 10 x 5 x 3.6 in. (25.4 x 12.7 x 9.1cm) | 13 x 8.2 x 3.8 in. (33 x 20.8 x 9.7cm) | 16.2 x 11.3 x 4 in. (41.1 x 28.7 x 10.2cm) |
Electrical Requirements | 230V 50/60Hz | 230V 50/60Hz | 230V 50/60Hz |
Plug Type | EU/UK/AUS/CHN-style | EU | EU |
Max. Temperature (Metric) | 540°C | 540°C | 400°C |
Type | Hotplate & Stirrer | Hotplate & Stirrer | Hotplate & Stirrer |

Cimarec+ Hotplate series
[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Hotplate & Stirrer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text][/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Our new Thermo Scientific™ Cimarec+™ hotplate series offers exceptional safety and temperature performance for your routine protocols. The Cimarec+ Series are available in three sizes, providing flexibility from microscale chemistries to production operations.
Advanced technology
- Temperature adjustable in 1 degree increments
- Hot Top warning system protects from accidental burns with prominent display when heating surface is above 50°C (122°F)
- Top plate choices in ceramic or aluminum
- Easy-to-read LED display for heating
- Raised display design protects electronics from spills
- Optional temperature probe and splash guard protection shield
- Variable sizes for different sample volumes
Model No. | HP88854105 | HP88857105 | HP88850105 |
Temperature Range (Metric) | 540°C (Max Temperature) | 540°C (Max Temperature) | 540°C (Max Temperature) |
Max. Temperature (Metric) | 540°C | 540°C | 400°C |
Voltage | 230V | 230V | 230V |
Top Plate Material | Ceramic | Ceramic | Ceramic |
Surface Area (English) Heating | 4.25 x 4.25 in. | 7.25 x 7.25 in. | 10.25 x 10.25 in. |
Surface Area (Metric) Heating | 10.8 x 10.8cm | 18.4 x 18.4cm | 26.0 x 26.0cm |
Hertz | 50/60Hz | 50/60Hz | 50/60Hz |
Certifications/Compliance | cCSAus, CE | cCSAus, CE | cCSAus, CE |
Dimensions (L x W x H) | 10 x 5 x 3.6 in. (25.4 x 12.7 x 9.1cm) | 13 x 8.2 x 3.8 in. (33 x 20.8 x 9.7cm) | 16.2 x 11.3 x 4 in. (41.1 x 28.7 x 10.2cm) |
Electrical Requirements | 230V 50/60Hz | 230V 50/60Hz | 230V 50/60Hz |
Weight (English) | 6.8 lb. | 10.8 lb. | 16.0 lb. |
Weight (Metric) | 3.1kg | 4.9kg | 7.3kg |
Type | Hotplates | Hotplate | Hotplate |

CORNING Stirring Hotplate
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/3"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="2/3"][vc_column_text]Corning® 5 x 7 Inch Top PC-420D Stirring Hot Plate with Digital Displays, 230V/50Hz
The Corning® PC-420D stirring hot plate has a 5 x 7 (12.7 x 17.8cm) Pyroceram® top and digital temperature and stirring speed displays. It is designed to operate on 230V/50Hz with either the BS 1363A or CEE7-7 plug (both included) for use in parts of Europe, Asia, Africa, Australia and other areas with similar electrical requirements. A Model PC-420D is shown to the left with optional temperature controller and support rod (Cat. No. 440129). This product is CE marked and UL/cUL approved.
- Microprocessor maintains consistent and repeatable temperature settings from 5°C (if ambient temperature is 0°C or lower) up to 550°C.
- Digital LED temperature display is adjustable in 5°C increments and blinks until set temperature is reached.
- Optional external temperature controller (Cat. No. 6795PR) truly controls temperature inside the vessel.
Product Number | 6796-420D |
Number of Stirring Positions | 1 |
Top Size | 5 x 7 inches |
Power | 230V, 50Hz |
Amperage | 698 |
Watts | 3.1 |
Stir Range | 60 - 1,150 rpm |
Temperature Range | 5 to 550° C (41 to 1022°F) |
Dimensions L x W x H | 40.1 x 26.9 x 12.2 cm (approx.) |

CORNING Hotplate 10″x10″
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/3"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="2/3"][vc_column_text]Corning® 10 x 10 Inch Top PC-600D Hot Plate with Digital Display, 230V/50Hz
The Corning® PC-600D hot plate has a 10 x 10 (25.4 x 25.4cm) Pyroceram® top and digital temperature display. It is designed to operate on 230V/50Hz with either the BS 1363A or CEE7-7 plug (both included) for use in parts of Europe, Asia, Africa, Australia and other areas with similar electrical requirements. This product is CE marked and UL/cUL approved.
- Microprocessor maintains consistent and repeatable temperature settings from 5°C (if ambient temperature is 0°C or lower) up to 550°C.
- Digital LED temperature display is adjustable in 5°C increments and blinks until set temperature is reached.
- Optional external temperature controller (Cat. No. 6795PR) truly controls temperature inside the vessel.
Product Inforamtion:
Product Number | 6796-600D |
Qty./Pk | 1 / Pk |
Qty./CS | 1 / Cs |
Brand | Corning® |
Number of Stirring Positions | 1 |
Top Size | 10 x 10 inches |
Power | 230V, 50Hz |
Amperage | 4.5 |
Watts | 1043 |
Temperature Range | 5 to 550° C (41 to 1022°F) |
Dimensions L x W x H | 15.37 x 11 x 4.62 inches (approx.) |

加热板,搅拌板和加热搅拌板
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Hotplate & Stirrer[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_single_image image="329" img_size="full"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Benchmark hotplates, stirrers and hotplate-stirrers feature an exceptionally durable, chemical resistant, white ceramic work surface. Their space-efficient design (7 X 10.5 in. footprint), makes them ideal for use on crowded benchtops and inside bio-hoods.
Advanced microprocessor controls allow quick, precise adjustment of speed and temperature. The large, backlit LCD display provides constant visualization of the speed and temperature while a safety LED indicates when the top plate is above 50°C. In addition, an optional probe is available for applications that require precise temperature contol. When connected, the probe provides direct feedback to the microprocessor,
which continuously adjusts and maintains the selected temperature in the sample within +/- 0.5°C.
With a square 6.5 in. work surface, all three models are compatible with a wide variety of popular sizes of borosilicate glass beakers, flasks, bottles and other vessels. An optional support rod (H3760-ROD) is available for mounting thermometers, temperature probes, etc.
- Large , backlit LCD display
- Ceramic work surface, 6.5 x 6.5 in.
- Safety LED indicates hot surface
- Control actual temperature (with optional probe)
- Three models: heat-stir, heat only or stir only
Specifications:
Temp. Range: | Ambient +5 to 380°C |
Speed Range: | 200 to 1500 rpm |
Platform Dimensions: | 6.5 x 6.5 in./ 16.6 x 16.5 cm |
Operating Temp. Range | +4 to +65°C |
Dimensions: (w x d x h) | 7 x 10.5 x 4 in./ 18 x 26 x 10.1 cm |
Weight: | 6.4 lbs. / 2.9kg |
Electrical: | 120 or 230V, 50-60Hz 500W |
Ordering information:
H3760-HS-E | Benchmark Digital Hotplate & Stirrer, EU plug |
H3760-S-E | Benchmark Digital Magnetic Stirrer, EU plug |
H3760-H-E | Benchmark Digital Hotplate, EU plug |
H3760-TP | Optional Temperature Probe |
H3760-ROD | Optional Support Rod |

- 大尺寸,背光LCD显示屏
- 陶瓷面板, 16.5 x 16.5 cm
- 安全LED提示热表面
- 控制实际温度(需要配温度探头)
- 三种类型:加热, 搅拌或者加热搅拌
规格
温度范围 | 室温 +5 至 380°C |
速度范围 | 200 至 1500 rpm |
平台尺寸 | 16.5 x 16.5 cm |
使用温度范围 | +4 to +65°C |
尺寸(w x d x h) | 18 x 26 x 10.1 cm |
重量 | 2.9kg |
电源 | 230V, 50-60Hz 500W |

KB 系列 | 低温培养箱 利用压缩机技术
Special features
- Temperature range:
- -5 °C to 100 °C (except KB23)
- 0°C to 100 °C (KB23 only)
- Up to 30% lower energy consumption compared to the previous model
- Cooling with compressor cooling unit
- Adjustable fan speed
- Controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Inner door made of tempered safety glass
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KB 23 | 20 | 435x620x520 | 222x330x277 |
KB 53 | 53 | 635x835x580 | 400x400x330 |
KB 115 | 115 | 835x1025x650 | 600x480x400 |
KB 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KB 400 | 400 | 925x1950x805 | 650x1270x485 |
KB 720 | 698 | 1250x1925x885 | 970x1250x576 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
KB 23 | 20 | 435x620x520 | 222x330x277 |
KB 53 | 53 | 635x835x580 | 400x400x330 |
KB 115 | 115 | 835x1025x650 | 600x480x400 |
KB 240 | 247 | 925x1465x800 | 650x785x485 |
KB 400 | 400 | 925x1950x805 | 650x1270x485 |
KB 720 | 698 | 1250x1925x885 | 970x1250x576 |

KT 系列 | 低温培养箱 利用帕尔贴技术
Special features
- Temperature range: 4 °C to 100 °C
- Electric cooling with Peltier module
- Adjustable fan speed
- Controller with time-segment and real-time programming
- Inner door made of tempered safety glass
- Data recording and USB interface
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
KT 53 | 53 | 660x635x630 | 400x400x334 |
KT 115 | 102 | 860x715x655 | 600x455x355 |
KT 170 | 163 | 860x1025x655 | 600x765x355 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
KT 53 | 53 | 660x635x630 | 400x400x334 |
KT 115 | 102 | 860x715x655 | 600x455x355 |
KT 170 | 163 | 860x1025x655 | 600x765x355 |

B 系列 | 培养箱 Classic.Line 利用机械调整
Special features
- Temperature range: 30 °C to 70 °C
- Hydro-mechanical thermostat
- Inner door made of tempered safety glass
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
B 28 | 28 | 580x405x425 | 400x280x250 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
B 28 | 28 | 580x405x425 | 400x280x250 |

BF 系列 | 培养箱 Classic.Line 带循环空气功能
Special features
- Temperature range: room temperature plus 5 °C to 100 °C
- Adjustable fan speed
- Adjustable exhaust air flap
- Controller with timer functions
- Inner door made of tempered safety glass
- Class 3.1 independent temperature safety device (DIN 12880) with visual temperature alarm
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
BF 400 | 400 | 1235x1025x765 | 1000x800x500 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
BF 400 | 400 | 1235x1025x765 | 1000x800x500 |

BF 系列 | 培养箱 Avantgarde.Line 利用循环空气
Special features
- Temperature range (model 56 | 260): ambient temperature plus 7 °C to 100 °C
- Temperature range (model 115): ambient temperature plus 8 °C to 100 °C
- Forced convection
- Controller with LCD display
- Electromechanical control of the exhaust air flap
- Class 3.1 integrated independent temperature safety device (DIN 12880) with visual alarm
- Excellent temporal and spatial temperature accuracy and high energy efficiency
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
BF 56 | 59 | 560x625x565 | 400x440x340 |
BF 115 | 114 | 710x735x605 | 510x550x380 |
BF 260 | 257 | 810x965x760 | 650x780x510 |
BF 720 | 734 | 1165x1590x870 | 1000x1300x565 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
BF 56 | 59 | 560x625x565 | 400x440x340 |
BF 115 | 114 | 710x735x605 | 510x550x380 |
BF 260 | 257 | 810x965x760 | 650x780x510 |
BF 720 | 734 | 1165x1590x870 | 1000x1300x565 |

BD 系列 | 培养箱 Classic.Line 带自由对流功能
Special features
- Temperature range: room temperature plus 5 °C to 100 °C
- natural convection
- Adjustable exhaust air flap
- Controller with timer functions
- Inner door made of tempered safety glass
- Class 3.1 independent temperature safety device (DIN 12880) with visual temperature alarm
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
BD 23 | 20 | 435x495x520 | 222x330x277 |
BD 400 | 400 | 1235x1025x765 | 1000x800x500 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
BD 23 | 20 | 435x495x520 | 222x330x277 |
BD 400 | 400 | 1235x1025x765 | 1000x800x500 |

BD 系列 | 培养箱 Avantgarde.Line 带自由对流功能
{:en}
- Temperature range: ambient temperature plus 5 °C to 100 °C
- Natural convection
- Controller with LCD display
- Electromechanical control of the exhaust air flap
- Class 3.1 integrated independent temperature safety device (DIN 12880) with visual alarm
- Excellent temporal and spatial temperature accuracy and high energy efficiency
Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
BD 56 | 57 | 560x625x565 | 360x420x380 |
BD 115 | 112 | 710x735x605 | 510x530x420 |
BD 260 | 253 | 810x965x760 | 610x760x545 |
BD 720 | 737 | 1165x1590x870 | 960x1280x600 |
重要特性
可选容积型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
BD 56 | 57 | 560x625x565 | 360x420x380 |
BD 115 | 112 | 710x735x605 | 510x530x420 |
BD 260 | 253 | 810x965x760 | 610x760x545 |
BD 720 | 737 | 1165x1590x870 | 960x1280x600 |

CB 系列 | CO₂ 培养箱 带热空气消毒功能和可高温消毒的 CO₂ 传感器
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]
The BINDER CB series CO₂ incubator is the premium class among the CO₂ incubators. It is suitable for all sensitive incubation applications and ensures optimal cell growth. A BINDER CB series CO₂ incubator can perform complex cultivation experiments as well as specific enviromental conditions.
CO₂ incubators with hot air sterilization and heat sterilizable CO₂ sensor
The Binder CB series is a world first! Fitted with a sterilizable CO₂ sensor, the incubator meets the highest of standards when it comes to sample safety and cell growth. While C series CO₂ incubators have been designed with standard laboratory applications in mind, the BINDER CB comes highly recommended for the incubation of delicate cells, providing optimum growth conditions for cell cultures. Just like the C series units, the CO₂ incubators in the CB series have the option of automatic sterilization with hot air at 180 °C. Plus, they have a heat sterilizable CO₂ sensor with infrared technology and come with a double-pan humidification system with condensation protection. The units feature tightly sealed inner doors made of tempered safety glass and a lockable door handle, guaranteeing maximum safety conditions for work in the laboratory.CO₂ incubators with a patented humidity management system
CB series CO₂ incubators have a patented humidity management system. The Permadry double-pan humidity system provides active humidity limitation that keeps even the interior walls dry. What's more, evaporation is kept to a minimum thanks to the high humidity. These CO₂ incubators are incredibly user-friendly, with the option to control all of the key parameters at once using the operating panel. Measured values are recorded continually and can be exported as data sets with ease via USB. Navigation is straightforward and intuitive. The CO₂ incubators with hot air sterilization and heat sterilizable CO₂ sensor are ideal for the incubation of delicate cells, guaranteeing optimum conditions for cell cultures along with high levels of safety and usability.[/vc_column_text][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner width="1/3"][vc_column_text]
Important characteristics
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column_inner][/vc_row_inner][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Model | Housing Dimensions (excluding fittings and connections) W x H x D (mm) | Internal Dimensions W x H x D (mm) | Net weight (kg) | Interior volume (L) |
---|---|---|---|---|
CB 60 | 580 x 720 x 545 | 400 x 400 x 330 | 68 | 53 |
CB 170 (new) | 680 x 870 x 715 | 560 x 600 x 505 | 95 | 170 |
CB 220 | 740 x 1070 x 715 | 560 x 750 x 500 | 132 | 210 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
CB 60 | 53 | 580x720x545 | 400x400x330 |
CB 160 | 150 | 680x920x715 | 500x600x500 |
CB 220 | 210 | 740x1070x715 | 560x750x500 |

重要特性
- 溫度範圍:環境溫度加上 7 °C 至 60 °C
- 濕度範圍:最高達 95% 相對濕度
- 可選 O₂ 調節範圍:2-20 Vol.-% O₂ 或 10-95 Vol.-% O₂ (版本 O、GO)
- 通過 180 °C 的熱風進行自動滅菌
- 帶冷凝保護的培養皿加濕系統
- 帶有文丘裡效應的 CO₂ 混合氣體噴嘴
- 可用熱風滅菌的採用紅外線技術的 CO₂ 感測器
- 通過 LCD 彩色顯示器進行顯示
- 可鎖閉的門把手
- 由安全玻璃 (ESG) 製成的密封內門
- 由不銹鋼製成的無縫拉深的內腔
- 由不銹鋼製成的 2/3 個打孔擱板
- 利用堆疊適配器可堆疊設備
- 採用光學和聲音報警的故障診斷系統
- 電腦介面:乙太網
- 內部測量值記錄和 USB 介面
Available Sizes
型號 | 內部容積 [L] | 包括加裝件和連接件的外殼尺寸 寬 x 高 x 深 [mm] | 內部尺寸 寬 x 高 x 深 [mm] |
CB 60 | 53 | 580x720x545 | 400x400x330 |
CB 160 | 150 | 680x920x715 | 500x600x500 |
CB 220 | 210 | 740x1070x715 | 560x750x500 |

Series C | CO2 incubators with hot air sterilization
Special features
- Temperature range: room temperature plus 7 °C to 50 °C
- Humidity range: up to 95 % RH
- Auto-sterilization with hot air at 180 °C
- Humidification system with condensation protection
- CO₂ gas-mixing jet with Venturi effect
- CO₂ sensor with infrared technology
- Display with 3-digit, 7-segment LEDs
- Door hinged right or left
- Tightly-sealed inner door made of tempered safety glass
- Seamless, deep-drawn inner stainless steel chamber
- 3 perforated stainless steel shelves
- Units are stackable with stacking adapter
- Troubleshooting system with visual and audible alarms
- Zero-voltage alarm contact

Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
C 170 | 168 | 740x870x715 | 560x600x500 |

重要特性
可选容积
型号 | 内部容积 [L] | 外壳尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) | 内部尺寸 宽 x 高 x 深 (mm) |
C 170 | 168 | 740x870x715 | 560x600x500 |

重要特性
- 溫度範圍:環境溫度加上 7 °C 至 50 °C
- 濕度範圍:最高達 95% 相對濕度
- 通過 180 °C 的熱風進行自動滅菌
- 帶冷凝保護的加濕系統
- 帶有文丘裡效應的 CO₂ 混合氣體噴嘴
- 採用紅外線技術的 CO₂ 感測器
- 通過 3 位元 7 段 LED 顯示
- 帶右側或左側限位器的門
- 由安全玻璃 (ESG) 製成的密封內門
- 由不銹鋼製成的無縫拉深的內腔
- 由不銹鋼製成的 3 個打孔擱板
- 帶堆疊適配器的可堆疊設備
- 採用光學和聲音報警的故障診斷系統

Available Sizes
Model | Interior Volume [L] | Outer Dimensions WxHxD mm | Internal Dimensions WxHxD mm |
C 170 | 168 | 740x870x715 | 560x600x500 |

Multitherm Shaker Touch
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_row_inner][vc_column_inner][vc_column_text]
Like the popular MultiTherm, the MultiTherm Touch features a broad temperature range to meet applications from denaturation of DNA to keeping samples cold (4°C) at the end of a protocol. An expanded speed range (to 3,000rpm), full-color touch screen, greater flexibility in programming and heated lid option set this new unit apart.
All operating parameters are easily entered and viewed on the large, full color, touch screen. Fifty programs can be stored, each including up to 5 steps. Programming features such as adjustable ramp rates, interval and directional mixing and preheat options can be set. A “short” button allows for immediate mixing at maximum speed. Fifteen block choices accommodate samples from 0.2ml to 50ml as well as a variety of plates. Blocks are quickly and easily interchanged without the use of tools and are automatically recognized by the software. Insulation protects the users from hot surfaces and helps to maintain block temperature.
Condensation can have negative effects on delicate samples and reactions by changing the concentration of reactants. The heated lid option, available for use with tubes up to 5ml and microplates, protects samples by warming the air in the tube and preventing condensation. Easy to use and reliable in operation, the MultiTherm Touch is covered by a 1 year warranty. Blocks and heated lid are sold separately.[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
- Large touch screen for simple and easy programming and viewing of status
- Advanced programming features include adjustable ramp rates, preheat and clockwise/counterclockwise mixing
- Multiple block options for plates and tubes up to 50ml
- Broad temperature and speed range to meet a variety of applications
Display: | 4.3 inch color touch screen with graphical interface |
Speed: | 200 to 3000 rpm (block dependent) |
Orbit: | 3mm |
Temp. Range: | Ambient -20 to 105°C |
Temperature Uniformity: | ±0.5°C |
Timer: | 1s-99h:59m:59s or continuous |
Program Memory: | 50 programs |
Steps/Program: | 5 steps/program |
Programming Features: | Adjustable ramp rate, mix mode, mix start, power failure restart, and heated lid temp |
Additional Features: | Quick button, pause, import/export data and programs, automatic block recognition |
Dimensions: (w x d x h) | 6.3 x 12.6 x 8.7 in. / 16 x 32 x 22 cm |
Weight: | 22 lbs/10kg |
Electrical: | 110 to 240V 50-60Hz |







H5100-HCT | MultiTherm Touch, Heating/Cooling Vortexer, blocks sold separately |
H5100-HL | Heated lid for above |
Available blocks (max speed) | |
H5100-05 | 24 x 0.5ml (2,000rpm) |
H5100-15 | 35 x 1.5ml (2,000rpm) |
H5100-20 | 35 x 2ml (2,000rpm) |
H5100-CMB | 15 x 0.5ml and 20 x 1.5ml (2,000rpm) |
H5100-5MT | 8 x 5ml (1,000rpm) |
H5100-12 | 24 x 12mm dia. tube (2,000rpm) |
H5100-2CR | 24 x 1.5/2ml cryovials (2,000rpm) |
H5100-150 | 8 x 15ml (1,000rpm) |
H5100-500 | 4 x 50ml (1,000rpm) |
H5100-MP | Standard microplate (3,000rpm) |
More blocks are available … |

Premium Stackable Shaking Incubator
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
ZWYR-D2402
ZWYR-D2401 with P5010-50

ZWYR-D2403 with P5017
[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
ZWYR-D2401 with P5010-35
[/vc_column_text][vc_btn title="Download Brochure" style="flat" shape="square" color="chino" align="center" i_icon_fontawesome="fa fa-download" button_block="true" add_icon="true" link="url:http%3A%2F%2Fwww.labwit.com.au%2Ffiles%2FPremium%2520Stackable%2520Shaking%2520Incubators%2520V2020.1.0.pdf||target:%20_blank|"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
- Single unit of 190L, shaking tray 800x430mm
- All premium features apply
- Full temperature control with cooling for 4-60ºC operation
- Orbital movement with shaking diameter of 1-50mm stepless adjustable
- Fold-down front door and sliding tray designed for easy operation
- UV light reduces the air burden, keeping the chamber contamination free.
- *H35cm & H50cm base option available
- Doubled volume, 190Lx2, Shaking tray 800X430mm
- All premium features apply
- Full temperature control with cooling for 4-60ºC operation
- Orbital movement with shaking diameter of 1-50mm stepless adjustable
- Fold-down front door and sliding tray designed for easy operation
- UV light reduces the air burden, keeping the chamber contamination free.
- Tripled volume, 190Lx3, Shaking tray 800X430mm
- All premium features apply
- Full temperature control with cooling for 4-60ºC operation
- Orbital movement with shaking diameter of 1-50mm stepless adjustable
- Fold-down front door and sliding tray designed for easy operation.
- Fold-up door option (#P5017) available for ZWYR-D2403 for easy loading on the top unit.
- UV light reduces the air burden, keeping the chamber contamination free.
Flask (ml) | 50ml | 100ml | 250ml | 500ml | 750ml | 1000ml | 2000ml | P8010 | P8012 |
ZWYR-D2401 | 91 | 50 | 38 | 26 | 15 | 15 | 8 | 8 | 19 |
ZWYR-D2402 | 180 | 100 | 76 | 52 | 30 | 30 | 16 | 16 | 38 |
ZWYR-D2403 | 270 | 150 | 114 | 78 | 45 | 45 | 24 | 24 | 57 |
Model | ZWYR-D2401 | ZWYR-D2402 | ZWYR-D2403 |
Control | P.I.D. Microprocessor | ||
Control Mode | Fix Value or Program (up to 9 Segments) | ||
Control Panel | LCD Touch Screen | ||
Air Convection | Forced | ||
Shaking Mode | Orbit | ||
Volume/Compartment (L) | 190 | ||
Ambient Temperature(ºC) | Oct-35 | ||
Shaking Speed (rpm) | 30-300 | ||
Stroke (mm) | Ø1-50 Stepless Adjustable | ||
Temperature Range (ºC) | Apr-60 | ||
Temperature Accuracy (ºC) | 0.1 | ||
Temperature Uniformity (ºC) | ±0.5ºC@37℃ | ||
Timer | 1 to 9999 mins | ||
Tray (mm) (WxD) | 800×430 | ||
Tray Included | 1 | 2 | 3 |
Inner Dimensions (mm) (WxDxH) | 920x532x395 | ||
Exterior Dimensions (mm) (Wx Dx H) | 1300x930x735 | 1300x930x1315 | 1300x930x1895 |
Net/Gross Weight (kg) | 250/290 | 430/500 | 630/730 |
Power (W) | 1200 | 2400 | 3600 |
Electricity | 220-240V 50/60Hz | ||
Approval | CE, ISO | ||
Security | Over-temperature Protection, Compressor Overload Protection, Electrical Leakage Protection | ||
Additional | Built-in Printer, RS485 Interface (Option), LED Lighting Control Kit (Option), Base Stand(Option) |

Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_column_text]
ZWY-2102C
[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
ZWY-2112B[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
Double Layer Shaking Frame
[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
These LABWIT double layer shaking incubators are specially developed for the modern biological engineering departments; a big capacity of flasks but with small footprint.
These incubators have a smooth compact design. They are very efficient and have an excellent floor space/performance factor. Two trays above each other, double the capacity for smaller flasks, while after removing the top tray, big flasks can also be used on the bottom tray (Shaking frame upgrade required). These unit are particularly ideal for fermentation and pharmacy experiments. While they are also widely used where a big amount of liquid needed to be mixed at with constant temperature.
Features:
♦ Microprocessor controller with audible and visual alarms maintains precise temperature and speed control.
♦ Users friendly control panel allows easy digital setting of time, temperature and speed.
♦ Large LCD display presents all actual and preset parameters.
♦ Electronic timer, from 0 – 500 hours, automatic stop, audio/ visual alarm.
♦ Password protection against unauthorized change of parameters.
♦ Audible and visual alarms for over-temperature and set point deviations.
♦ Non-volatile memory for set point retention after a power interruption.
♦ Large double-fold tempered glass window, together with fluorescent lights provides complete visibility of chamber interior.
♦ “Long-Life” brushless AC motor creates a smooth, quiet and uniformed shaking motion.
♦ Mirror-finished high quality #304 stainless steel for excellent durability of interiors.
♦ Standard shaking frame and standard stainless steel tray included, but without clamps.
♦ Vertical double trays for big capacity, though small footprint.
♦ Lockable outer door (on ZWY-1112B/2112B. ZWF-1112/2112) protects the materials against unauthorized access at all times.[/vc_column_text][vc_column_text]
Flask (ml) | 50ml | 100ml | 250ml | 500ml | 750ml | 1000ml | 2000ml | 3000ml | 5000ml |
ZWY-1102C/2102C | 56 | 56 | 28 | 22 | 18 | 6* | 3* | 2* | 2* |
ZWY-1102/2102 | 104 | 104 | 56 | 44 | 30 | 24 | 7* | 6* | 4* |
ZWY-1112B/2112B | 164 | 164 | 90 | 74 | 52 | 36 | 13* | 8* | 6* |
ZWF-1112/2112 | 164 | 164 | 90 | 76 | 48 | 44 | 12* | 8* | 6* |
*Applies only when single layer shaking frame is equipped. |
Model | ZWY-1102C | ZWY-2102C | ZWY-1102 | ZWY-2102 | ZWY-1112B | ZWY-2112B | ZWF-1112 | ZWF-2112 |
Volume (L) | 170 | 330 | 580 | 580 | ||||
Shaking Mode | Oribtal | Orbital | Orbital | Reciprocal | ||||
Temperature (°C) | A +5 to 60 | 4 to 60 | A +5 to 60 | 4 to 60 | A +5 to 60 | 4 to 60 | A +5 to 60 | 4 to 60 |
Temperature Accuracy | ±0.1°C | |||||||
Temperature Uniformity | ≤±1°C@37°C | |||||||
Stroke (mm) | 26 | 26 | 35 | 1 to 50 Stepless Adjustment | ||||
Speed (rpm) | 30-300 | 30-300 | 30-300 | 30-240 | ||||
Tray (mm) (WxD) | 496x350 | 734x458 | 970x560 | 940x580 | ||||
Inner dimensions (mm) (WxDxH) | 615x450x640 | 845x530x765 | 1105x850x664 | 1105x850x664 | ||||
Exteriro dimensions (mm) (WxDxH) | 720x685x1310 | 950x755x1445 | 1430x880x1700 | 1430x880x1700 | ||||
Packing dimensions (mm) (WxDxH) | 790x755x1470 | 1020x825x1605 | 1500x950x1860 | 1500x950x1860 | ||||
Net/Gross Weight (kg) | 150/175 | 165/190 | 225/265 | 235/272 | 425/505 | 456/536 | 455/535 | 486/562 |
Power (W) | 1000 | 1250 | 1050 | 1300 | 1600 | 1950 | 1600 | 1950 |
Electricity | 220-240V 50/60Hz | |||||||
Approval | CE, ISO |
Order no. | Description |
ZWY-1102C | 170L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator A+5-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWY-2102C | 170L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator 4-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWY-1102 | 330L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator A+5-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWY-2102 | 330L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator 4-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWY-1112B | 580L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator A+5-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWY-2112B | 580L, Economic Double Layer Shaking Incubator 4-60, 30-300rpm |
ZWF-1112 | 580L, Economic Reciprocal Double Layer Shaking Incubator A+5-60, 30-240rpm |
ZWF-2112 | 580L, Economic Reciprocal Double Layer Shaking Incubator 4-60, 30-240rpm |
Order no. | Description | Order no. | Description |
P5001 | Frame for ZWY-1102C/2102C, ZWYR-2102C, Stl S/C # | P8002 | T Clamp, S/S, for 100ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P5002 | Frame for ZWY-1102/2102, ZWYR-2102, S/C | P8013 | T Clamp, S/S, for 150ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P5003 | Frame for ZWY-1112B/2112B, ZWYR-2112B, Stl S/C | P8003 | T Clamp, S/S, for 250ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P6010 | Tray for ZWY-1102C/2102C, ZWYR-2102C, S/S※ | P8014 | T Clamp, S/S, for 300ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P6011 | Tray for ZWY-1102/2102, ZWYR-2102, S/S | P8004 | T Clamp, S/S, for 500ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P6012 | Tray for ZWY-1112B/2112B, ZWYR-2112B, S/S | P8005 | T Clamp, S/S, for 750ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P6013 | Tray for ZWF-1112/2112, ZWFR-2112, S/S | P8006 | T Clamp, S/S, for 1000ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P7011 | Universal Tray for ZWY-1102C/2102C, ZWYR-2102C | P8007 | T Clamp, Spring S/S, for 2000ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P7012 | Universal Tray for ZWY-1102/2102, ZWYR-2102, Ful Pcs | P8008 | T Clamp, Spring S/S, for 3000ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P7013 | Universal Tray for ZWY-1112B/2112B, ZWYR-2112B, Ful Pcs | P8009 | T Clamp, Spring S/S, for 5000ml Flask, with Spring Retainer |
P7014 | Universal Tray for ZWF-1112/2112, ZWFR-2112, Ful Pcs | P8010 | Tube Rack S/S |
P7023 | Universal Tray for All Double Layer Model, 1/2 Pcs | P8011 | Tube Rack ABS Plastic |
P8001 | T Clamp, S/S, for 50ml Flask, with Spring Retainer | P8012 | Clamp for 96 Well MicroPlate, S/S |
# Stl S/C:Spray Coated Steel, ※ S/S: Stainless Steel | P8017 | Sticky Mat, 20 x 20cm |

Incu-Shaker 10LR Shaking Incubator with cooling
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4158,4151" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Incu-Shaker™ 10L is a heavy-duty performer, designed for heavy workloads and continuous use. Its outstanding temperature accuracy and uniformity are supported by proprietary heat distribution technology that ensures that temperatures are precisely maintained throughout the chamber. Inconsistencies due to stratification are reduced to negligible levels and the selected temperature is precisely maintained within 0.25%, even in the corners.
The powerful brushless induction drive is designed for years of trouble-free service, even under continuous use conditions with heavy loads. Noise and vibration are minimized by an advanced, computer designed motor isolation system. Like other Incu-Shaker models, the 10L is built to last.
A standard, rubber mat platform is included and is ideal for use with tissue culture flasks, Petri dishes, staining trays and other flat vessels. The convenient MAGic Clamp™ platformis also available for use with Erlenmeyer flasks and test tube racks. The unique, magnetic attachment method (PATENTED) is the easiest way to instantly change between flask clamps of different sizes.
- Large 18 x 18", up to 5 x 2L
- Exceptional temperature uniformity
- Horizontally circular 19mm orbit for aeration & mixing
- Instantly change flask clamps with MAGic Clamp™ accessories
- Optional shelf for Petri dishes, microplates, etc.
- Incu-Shaker 10LR (Refrigerated) for temperatures down to RT -15°C
Speed: | Variable, 30 to 300 rpm |
Orbit: | 19mm / 3/4 in. |
Temp. Range (10LR): | Room Temp. -15°C to 60°C |
Temp. Increment: | 0.1°C |
Temp. Accuracy: | ±0.1°C |
Temp. Uniformity: | ±1.25°C |
Speed Increment: | 1 rpm |
Platform Dimensions: | 17.8 x 17.8 in./ 45 x 45 cm |
Dimensions: (w x d x h) | 20 x 26 x 19 in. / 51 x 65 x 47 cm |
Dimensions (10LR): (w x d x h) | 20 x 31 x 22 in. / 51 x 79 x 56 cm |
Weight (10LR): | 120 lbs (55kg) |
Height, Lid Open: | 38 in. / 96.5 cm |
Timer: | 1 min. to 48 hours / continuous |
Electrical: | 115 or 230V, 50-60Hz, 450W |
Order No.: | Description: |
H1012-E | Incu-Shaker 10LR (Refrigerated) with flat mat platform |
Optional Platforms | |
H1010-MR | MAGic Clamp™ universal platform for flasks and tube racks (18 x 18 in.) |
H1010-P-SP | Spring platform for unique vessel types |
H1010-P-MP | 6 x microplate platform |
H1010-SH | Optional shelf, 14 x 5,5" for Petri dishes, microplates, etc. |
MAGic Clamp Flask Clamps | |
H1000-MR-CMB | ADJUSTABLE flask clamp, accepts 125ml, 250ml & 500ml (max. 16x500, 25x250 or 36x125ml) |
H1000-MR-25 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 25ml, max.49 |
H1000-MR-50 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 50ml, max.49 |
H1000-MR125 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 125ml, max.36 |
H1000-MR-250 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 250ml, max.25 |
H1000-MR-500 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 500ml, max.16 |
H1000-MR-1000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 1L, max. 9 |
H1000-MR-2000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 2L, max.5 |
H1000-MR-3000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 2.8L, max.4 |
H1000-MR-MP | Clamp for 1 x microplate for H1000-MR, max. 6 |
MAGic Clamp Tube/Bottle Racks | |
H1000-MR-1550 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 30x15ml & 20x50ml, max. 4 |
H1000-MR-T15 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 32x15ml, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-T50 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 15x50ml, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-T600 | Bottle Rack for H1000-MR, 4x500/600ml bottle, max. 4 |
H1000-MR-TSR | Tilted holder for 15ml and 50ml tube racks, max 8 |

Incu-Shaker 10L Shaking Incubator
[vc_row][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4154,4151" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
Incu-Shaker™ 10L is a heavy-duty performer, designed for heavy workloads and continuous use. Its outstanding temperature accuracy and uniformity are supported by proprietary heat distribution technology that ensures that temperatures are precisely maintained throughout the chamber. Inconsistencies due to stratification are reduced to negligible levels and the selected temperature is precisely maintained within 0.25%, even in the corners.
The powerful brushless induction drive is designed for years of trouble-free service, even under continuous use conditions with heavy loads. Noise and vibration are minimized by an advanced, computer designed motor isolation system. Like other Incu-Shaker models, the 10L is built to last.
A standard, rubber mat platform is included and is ideal for use with tissue culture flasks, Petri dishes, staining trays and other flat vessels. The convenient MAGic Clamp™ platform is also available for use with Erlenmeyer flasks and test tube racks. The unique, magnetic attachment method (PATENTED) is the easiest way to instantly change between flask clamps of different sizes.
- Large 18 x 18", up to 5 x 2L
- TOUCH screen control over time, speed and temperature
- Exceptional temperature uniformity
- Horizontally circular 19mm orbit for aeration & mixing
- Instantly change flask clamps with MAGic Clamp™ accessories
- Optional shelf for Petri dishes, microplates, etc.
Speed: | Variable, 30 to 300 rpm |
Orbit: | 19mm / 3/4 in. |
Temp. Range: | Room Temp. +5 to 60°C |
Temp. Increment: | 0.1°C |
Temp. Accuracy: | ±0.1°C |
Temp. Uniformity: | ±1.25°C |
Speed Increment: | 1 rpm |
Platform Dimensions: | 17.8 x 17.8 in./ 45 x 45 cm |
Dimensions: (w x d x h) | 20 x 26 x 19 in. / 51 x 65 x 47 cm |
Weight: | 120 lbs (55kg) |
Height, Lid Open: | 38 in. / 96.5 cm |
Timer: | 1 min. to 48 hours / continuous |
Electrical: | 115 or 230V, 50-60Hz, 450W |
Order no.: | Description: |
H2010-E | Incu-Shaker 10L with flat mat platform |
Optional Platforms | |
H1010-MR | MAGIc Clamp universal platform for flasks and tube racks (18 x 18 in.) |
H1010-P-SP | Spring platform for unique vessel types |
H1010-P-MP | 6 x microplate platform |
H1010-SH | Optional shelf, 14 x 5,5" for Petri dishes, microplates, etc |
MAGic Clamp Flask Clamps | |
H1000-MR-CMB | ADJUSTABLE flask clamp, accepts 125ml, 250ml & 500ml (max. 16x500, 25x250 or 36x125ml) |
H1000-MR-25 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 25ml, max.49 |
H1000-MR-50 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 50ml, max.49 |
H1000-MR-125 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 125ml, max.36 |
H1000-MR-250 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 250ml, max.25 |
H1000-MR-500 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 500ml, max.16 |
H1000-MR-1000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 1L, max. 9 |
H1000-MR-2000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 2L, max.5 |
H1000-MR-3000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 2.8L, max.4 |
H1000-MR-MP | Clamp for 1 x microplate for H1000-MR, max. 6 |
MAGic Clamp Tube/Bottle Racks | |
H1000-MR-1550 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 30x15ml & 20x50ml, max. 4 |
H1000-MR-T15 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 32x15ml, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-T50 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 15x50ml, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-T600 | Bottle Rack for H1000-MR, 4x500/600ml bottle, max. 4 |
H1000-MR-T15H | Tube Rack, 12x1.5ml horizontal, max. 6 |
H1000-MR-T150H | Tube Rack, 4x15ml horizontal, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-T50H | Tube Rack, 2x50ml horizontal, max. 8 |
H1000-MR-TSR | Tilted holder for 15ml and 50ml tube racks, max 8 |

振荡培养箱
{:en}[vc_row][vc_column][vc_column_text]Your Location: Main page > Equipment > Incubating Shaker[/vc_column_text][/vc_column][/vc_row][vc_row full_height="yes" columns_placement="top"][vc_column width="1/4"][vc_images_carousel images="4150,4151,4152" img_size="full" autoplay="yes" hide_pagination_control="yes" wrap="yes"][/vc_column][vc_column width="3/4"][vc_column_text]
The Incu-Shaker™ Mini is the most compact shaking incubator in its class. Despite the remarkably small footprint, a large 11.5 x 9.5 in. work space accepts several platforms and a variety of flasks, tubes and other common vessels.
The standard platform (included) features a non-slip, rubber coated surface, ideal for tissue culture flasks, Petri dishes and staining trays.
The convenient MAGic Clamp™ (PATENTED) platform is also available for use with Erlenmeyer flasks and test tube racks. The unique, magnetic attach- ment method is the easiest way to instantly change between flask clamps of different sizes.
- Extremely compact, just 11" wide
- Exceptional temperature uniformity
- Horizontally circular 19mm orbit for aeration & mixing
- Instantly exchange flask clamps with MAGic Clamp™ accessories (PATENTED)
Temperature Range: | Ambient +5° to 70°C |
Temperature Increments: | +0.1°C |
Temperature Uniformity: | ±0.25°C |
Temperature Accuracy: | ±0.1°C |
Shaking Speed Range: | 30 to 300rpm |
Speed Increments: | 1rpm |
Shaking Orbit: | 19mm (4/4") |
Operating Temp Range: | +4 to +65°C |
Platform Dimensions: | 9.5 x 11.5 in./28 x 41 x 33 cm |
Exterior Dimensions (W x D x H): | 11 x 16.2 x 13 in. / 28 x 41 x 33 cm |
Height with Lid Open: | 25 in. / 63 cm |
Timer: | 1 min. to 48 hours / continuous |
Weight: | 25 lbs (11.5kg) |
Electrical: | 115 or 230V, 50-60Hz, 300W |
Order no. | Description |
H1001-M-E | Incu-Shaker Mini with flat mat platform |
Optional Platforms | |
H1000-MR | MAGic Clamp™ universal platform for flasks and tube racks (9.5 x 11.5) |
H1000-P-MP | 4 x microplate platform |
H1000-P-SP | Spring platform for unique vessel types |
MAGic Clamp™ Accessories | |
H1000-MR-CMB | ADJUSTABLE flask clamp, accepts 125ml, 250ml & 500ml (max. 5x500, 8x250 or 12x125ml) |
H1000-MR-25 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 25ml, max.20 |
H1000-MR-50 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 50ml, max.20 |
H1000-MR-125 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 125ml, max.12 |
H1000-MR-250 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 250ml, max.8 |
H1000-MR-500 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 500ml, max.5 |
H1000-MR-1000 | Flask clamp for H1000-MR, 1000ml max. 2 |
H1000-MR-MP | Clamp for 1 x microplate for H1000-MR, max. 4 |
H1000-MR-1550 | Tube Rack, 30x15ml &20x50ml tubes with Magnets on Bottom (max. 1) |
H1000-MR-T15 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 32x15ml, max. 2 |
H1000-MR-T50 | Tube Rack for H1000-MR, 15x50ml, max. 2 |
H1000-MR-T600 | Rack for H1000-MR, 4x500/600ml bottle, max. 1 |
H1000-MR-T15H | Tube Rack, 12x1.5ml horizontal, max. 2 |
H1000-MR-TSR | Angled tube rack holder, adjustable tilt (max. 1) |

- 非常紧凑, 只有28cm宽
- 杰出的温度均匀性
- 水平19mm圆形轨道,可用于曝气和搅拌
- 瞬间更换瓶夹MAGic Clamp™ (专利)
规格
温度范围 | 室温 +5° to 70°C |
温度增量 | +0.1°C |
温度均匀性 | ±0.25°C |
温度精度 | ±0.1°C |
摇动速度范围 | 30 至 300rpm |
速度递增 | 1rpm |
摇动轨道 | 19mm |
使用温度范围 | +4 to +65°C |
平台尺寸 | 28 x 41 x 33 cm |
外壳尺寸 (W x D x H) | 28 x 41 x 33 cm |
盖打开时的高度 | 63 cm |
计时器 | 1 分钟至 48 小时 / 连续 |
重量 | 11.5kg |
电源 | 230V, 50-60Hz, 300W |